s/burtle/iterative
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
1e698235 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
9fe8321b 31@c This is updated by GNU Press.
e9c75b65 32@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c 33
87885426
FN
34@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 36
6c0e9fb3 37@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 38
c906108c 39@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 40@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
41@dircategory Programming & development tools.
42@direntry
c906108c 43* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
44@end direntry
45
c906108c
SS
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
9fe8321b
AC
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52Version @value{GDBVN}.
c906108c 53
8a037dd7 54Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
1e698235 55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 56
e9c75b65
EZ
57Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
58under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
59any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
60Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
61Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
62and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 63
6826cf00
EZ
64(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
65freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
66published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
67development.''
c906108c
SS
68@end ifinfo
69
70@titlepage
71@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 73@sp 1
c906108c 74@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
9e9c5ae7 75@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 76@page
c906108c
SS
77@tex
78{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 79\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
80\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82}
83@end tex
53a5351d 84
c906108c 85@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7 86Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
1e698235 871996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 88@sp 2
c906108c
SS
89Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9059 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 92ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
93
94Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
97Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 100
6826cf00
EZ
101(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104development.''
c906108c
SS
105@end titlepage
106@page
107
6c0e9fb3 108@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
109@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
c906108c
SS
111@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
9fe8321b 115This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
116@value{GDBVN}.
117
1e698235 118Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
119
120@menu
121* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128* Stack:: Examining the stack
129* Source:: Examining source files
130* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 131* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 132* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 133* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
134
135* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
136
137* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
138* Altering:: Altering execution
139* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
140* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 141* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
142* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 145* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
21c294e6 146* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
6d2ebf8b
SS
147* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
148* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 149* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
150
151* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
152* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
153
154* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
155* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
156* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 157* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 158* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
159* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
160 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 161* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
162* Index:: Index
163@end menu
164
6c0e9fb3 165@end ifnottex
c906108c 166
449f3b6c 167@contents
449f3b6c 168
6d2ebf8b 169@node Summary
c906108c
SS
170@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
171
172The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
173going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
174program was doing at the moment it crashed.
175
176@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
177these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
178
179@itemize @bullet
180@item
181Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
182
183@item
184Make your program stop on specified conditions.
185
186@item
187Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
188
189@item
190Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
191effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
192@end itemize
193
cce74817 194You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 195For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
196For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
197
cce74817 198@cindex Modula-2
e632838e
AC
199Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
200@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
c906108c 201
cce74817
JM
202@cindex Pascal
203Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
204nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
205entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
206syntax.
c906108c 207
c906108c
SS
208@cindex Fortran
209@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 210it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 211underscore.
c906108c 212
c906108c
SS
213@menu
214* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
215* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
216@end menu
217
6d2ebf8b 218@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
219@unnumberedsec Free software
220
5d161b24 221@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
222General Public License
223(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
224program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
225freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
226the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
227Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
228Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
229
230Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
231you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
232from anyone else.
233
2666264b 234@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
235
236The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
237the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
238include with the free software. Many of our most important
239programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
240texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
241when an important free software package does not come with a free
242manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
243gaps today.
244
245Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
246normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
247authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
248copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
249them from the free software world.
250
251That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
252from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
253manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
254only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
255contract to make it non-free.
256
257Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
258price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
259charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
260Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
261problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
262are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
263modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
264
265The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
266free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
267commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
268accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
269
270Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
271When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
272are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
273provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
274manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
275a changed version of the program is not really available to our
276community.
277
278Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
279acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
280author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
281authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
282to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
283may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
284with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
285are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
286of the manual.
287
288However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
289content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
290media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
291obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
292manual to replace it.
293
294Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
295lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
296free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
297the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
298realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
299the free software community.
300
301If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
302the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
303license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
304don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
305will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
306option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
307what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
308try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 309is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
310
311You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
312manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
313copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
314improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
315at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
316and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
317Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
318have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
319
320The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
321published by other publishers, at
322@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
323
6d2ebf8b 324@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
325@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
326
327Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
328other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
329development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
330of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
331to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
332file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
333blow-by-blow account.
334
335Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
336
337@quotation
338@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
339or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
340omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
341@end quotation
342
343So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
344particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
345releases:
299ffc64 346Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
347Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
348Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
349Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
350Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
351Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
352John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
353Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
354and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
355
356Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
357Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
358
b37052ae
EZ
359Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
360in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
361Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
362demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
363much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 364
b37052ae 365@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
366object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
367Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
368
369David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
370the original support for encapsulated COFF.
371
0179ffac 372Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
c906108c
SS
373
374Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
375Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
376support.
377Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
378Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
379Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
380David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
381Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
382Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
383Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
384Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
385Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
386Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
387Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
388Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
389Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
390Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
391Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
a37295f9 392Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
c906108c 393
1104b9e7 394Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
c906108c
SS
395
396Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
397libraries.
398
399Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
400about several machine instruction sets.
401
402Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
403remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
404contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
405and RDI targets, respectively.
406
407Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
408command-line editing and command history.
409
7a292a7a
SS
410Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
411Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 412
5d161b24 413Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 414He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 415symbols.
c906108c
SS
416
417Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
418Super-H processors.
419
420NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
421
422Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
423
424Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
425
426Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
427
96a2c332 428Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
429
430Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
431watchpoints.
432
433Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
434
435Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
436
437Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 438nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
439
440The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
441support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 442(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
443compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
444John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
445Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
446information in this manual.
447
b37052ae
EZ
448DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
449Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
450
96a2c332
SS
451Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
452development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
453fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
454Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
455Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
456Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
457Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
458addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
459JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
460Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
461Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
462Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
463Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
464Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
465Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 466
e2e0bcd1
JB
467Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
468Hat.
c906108c 469
6d2ebf8b 470@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
471@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
472
473You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
474However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
475debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
476
477@iftex
478In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
479to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
480@end iftex
481
482@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
483@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
484
485One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
486processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
487quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
488definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
489session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
490then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
491same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
492@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
493procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
494
495@smallexample
496$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
497$ @b{./m4}
498@b{define(foo,0000)}
499
500@b{foo}
5010000
502@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
503
504@b{bar}
5050000
506@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
507
508@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
509@b{baz}
510@b{C-d}
511m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
512@end smallexample
513
514@noindent
515Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
516
c906108c
SS
517@smallexample
518$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
519@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
520@c FIXME... format to come out better.
521@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 522 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 523 the conditions.
5d161b24 524There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
525 for details.
526
527@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
528(@value{GDBP})
529@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
530
531@noindent
532@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
533rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
534We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
535that examples fit in this manual.
536
537@smallexample
538(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
539@end smallexample
540
541@noindent
542We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
543Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
544@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
545@code{break} command.
546
547@smallexample
548(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
549Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
550@end smallexample
551
552@noindent
553Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
554control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
555subroutine, the program runs as usual:
556
557@smallexample
558(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
559Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
560@b{define(foo,0000)}
561
562@b{foo}
5630000
564@end smallexample
565
566@noindent
567To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
568suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
569context where it stops.
570
571@smallexample
572@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
573
5d161b24 574Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
575 at builtin.c:879
576879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
577@end smallexample
578
579@noindent
580Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
581the next line of the current function.
582
583@smallexample
584(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
585882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
586 : nil,
587@end smallexample
588
589@noindent
590@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
591by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
592@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
593subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
594
595@smallexample
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
597set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
598 at input.c:530
599530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
600@end smallexample
601
602@noindent
603The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
604suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
605shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
606command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
607in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
608stack frame for each active subroutine.
609
610@smallexample
611(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
612#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
613 at input.c:530
5d161b24 614#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
615 at builtin.c:882
616#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
617#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
618 at macro.c:71
619#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
620#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
621@end smallexample
622
623@noindent
624We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
625times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
626falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
627
628@smallexample
629(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6300x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
631(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6320x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
633def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
635536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
636 : xstrdup(rq);
637(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
638538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
639@end smallexample
640
641@noindent
642The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
643@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
644and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
645(@code{print}) to see their values.
646
647@smallexample
648(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
649$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
650(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
651$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
652@end smallexample
653
654@noindent
655@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
656To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
657surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
658
659@smallexample
660(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
661533 xfree(rquote);
662534
663535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
664 : xstrdup (lq);
665536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
666 : xstrdup (rq);
667537
668538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
669539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
670540 @}
671541
672542 void
673@end smallexample
674
675@noindent
676Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
677@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
678
679@smallexample
680(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
682(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
683540 @}
684(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
685$3 = 9
686(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
687$4 = 7
688@end smallexample
689
690@noindent
691That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
692@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
693@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
694the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
695any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
696assignments.
697
698@smallexample
699(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
700$5 = 7
701(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
702$6 = 9
703@end smallexample
704
705@noindent
706Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
707@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
708executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
709example that caused trouble initially:
710
711@smallexample
712(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
713Continuing.
714
715@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
716
717baz
7180000
719@end smallexample
720
721@noindent
722Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
723problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
724lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
725
726@smallexample
727@b{C-d}
728Program exited normally.
729@end smallexample
730
731@noindent
732The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
733indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
734session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
735
736@smallexample
737(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
738@end smallexample
c906108c 739
6d2ebf8b 740@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
741@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
742
743This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 744The essentials are:
c906108c 745@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 746@item
53a5351d 747type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 748@item
c906108c
SS
749type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
750@end itemize
751
752@menu
753* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
754* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
755* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
756@end menu
757
6d2ebf8b 758@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
759@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
760
c906108c
SS
761Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
762@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
763
764You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
765to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
766
c906108c
SS
767The command-line options described here are designed
768to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 769options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
770
771The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
772specifying an executable program:
773
474c8240 774@smallexample
c906108c 775@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 776@end smallexample
c906108c 777
c906108c
SS
778@noindent
779You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
780specified:
781
474c8240 782@smallexample
c906108c 783@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 784@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
785
786You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
787to debug a running process:
788
474c8240 789@smallexample
c906108c 790@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 791@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
792
793@noindent
794would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
795named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
796
c906108c 797Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
798complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
799debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
800``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
801will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 802
aa26fa3a
TT
803You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
804executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
805option processing.
474c8240 806@smallexample
aa26fa3a 807gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 808@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
809This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
810@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
811
96a2c332 812You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
813@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
814
815@smallexample
816@value{GDBP} -silent
817@end smallexample
818
819@noindent
820You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
821options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
822
823@noindent
824Type
825
474c8240 826@smallexample
c906108c 827@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 828@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
829
830@noindent
831to display all available options and briefly describe their use
832(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
833
834All options and command line arguments you give are processed
835in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
836@samp{-x} option is used.
837
838
839@menu
c906108c
SS
840* File Options:: Choosing files
841* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
842@end menu
843
6d2ebf8b 844@node File Options
c906108c
SS
845@subsection Choosing files
846
2df3850c 847When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
848specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
849the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
850@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
851first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
852equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
853second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
854equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
855If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
856first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
857to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
858a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 859prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
860
861If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
862such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
863argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
864
865Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
866following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
867them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
868(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
869than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
870
d700128c
EZ
871@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
872@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
873@c it.
874
c906108c
SS
875@table @code
876@item -symbols @var{file}
877@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
878@cindex @code{--symbols}
879@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
880Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
881
882@item -exec @var{file}
883@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
884@cindex @code{--exec}
885@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
886Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
887and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
888
889@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 890@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
891Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
892file.
893
c906108c
SS
894@item -core @var{file}
895@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
896@cindex @code{--core}
897@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 898Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
899
900@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
901@item -pid @var{number}
902@itemx -p @var{number}
903@cindex @code{--pid}
904@cindex @code{-p}
905Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
906If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
907file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
908
909@item -command @var{file}
910@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
911@cindex @code{--command}
912@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
913Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
914Files,, Command files}.
915
916@item -directory @var{directory}
917@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
918@cindex @code{--directory}
919@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
920Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
921
c906108c
SS
922@item -m
923@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
924@cindex @code{--mapped}
925@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
926@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
927supported on all systems.}@*
928If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 929system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
930to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
931program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 932called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
933Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
934and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
935the symbol table from the executable program.
936
937The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
938is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
939table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 940
c906108c
SS
941@item -r
942@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
943@cindex @code{--readnow}
944@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
945Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
946the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
947This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 948
c906108c
SS
949@end table
950
2df3850c 951You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 952order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
953information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
954on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
955but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 956
474c8240 957@smallexample
2df3850c 958gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 959@end smallexample
c906108c 960
6d2ebf8b 961@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
962@subsection Choosing modes
963
964You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
965batch mode or quiet mode.
966
967@table @code
968@item -nx
969@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
970@cindex @code{--nx}
971@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 972Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
973@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
974options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
975files}.
c906108c
SS
976
977@item -quiet
d700128c 978@itemx -silent
c906108c 979@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
980@cindex @code{--quiet}
981@cindex @code{--silent}
982@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
983``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
984messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
985
986@item -batch
d700128c 987@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
988Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
989command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
990initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
991nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
992in the command files.
993
2df3850c
JM
994Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
995example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
996make this more useful, the message
c906108c 997
474c8240 998@smallexample
c906108c 999Program exited normally.
474c8240 1000@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1001
1002@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1003(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1004@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1005mode.
1006
1007@item -nowindows
1008@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1009@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1010@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1011``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1012(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1013interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1014
1015@item -windows
1016@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1017@cindex @code{--windows}
1018@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1019If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1020used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1021
1022@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1023@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1024Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1025instead of the current directory.
1026
c906108c
SS
1027@item -fullname
1028@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1029@cindex @code{--fullname}
1030@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1031@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1032subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1033number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1034displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1035recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1036the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1037and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1038@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1039frame.
c906108c 1040
d700128c
EZ
1041@item -epoch
1042@cindex @code{--epoch}
1043The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1044@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1045routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1046separate window.
1047
1048@item -annotate @var{level}
1049@cindex @code{--annotate}
1050This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1051effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1052(@pxref{Annotations}).
1053Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1054together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1055types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1056@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1057maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1058
1059@item -async
1060@cindex @code{--async}
1061Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1062@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1063special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1064commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1065run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1066MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1067suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1068control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1069(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1070operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1071yet.)
1072@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1073@c should be removed.
1074
1075When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1076uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1077@samp{-noasync} option.
1078
1079@item -noasync
1080@cindex @code{--noasync}
1081Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1082
aa26fa3a
TT
1083@item --args
1084@cindex @code{--args}
1085Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1086executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1087This option stops option processing.
1088
2df3850c
JM
1089@item -baud @var{bps}
1090@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1091@cindex @code{--baud}
1092@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1093Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1094interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1095
1096@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1097@itemx -t @var{device}
1098@cindex @code{--tty}
1099@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1100Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1101@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1102
53a5351d 1103@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1104@item -tui
1105@cindex @code{--tui}
1106Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1107The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1108showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1109(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1110Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1111(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1112
1113@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1114@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1115@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1116@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1117@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1118@c systems.
1119
d700128c
EZ
1120@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1121@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1122Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1123program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0 1124communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
21c294e6 1125@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
94bbb2c0 1126
da0f9dcd
AC
1127@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1128@value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1129(@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1130interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1131@samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1132are not supported.
d700128c
EZ
1133
1134@item -write
1135@cindex @code{--write}
1136Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1137is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1138(@pxref{Patching}).
1139
1140@item -statistics
1141@cindex @code{--statistics}
1142This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1143memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1144
1145@item -version
1146@cindex @code{--version}
1147This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1148no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1149
c906108c
SS
1150@end table
1151
6d2ebf8b 1152@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1153@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1154@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1155@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1156
1157@table @code
1158@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1159@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1160@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1161@itemx q
1162To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1163@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1164do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1165otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1166error code.
c906108c
SS
1167@end table
1168
1169@cindex interrupt
1170An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1171terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1172returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1173character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1174until a time when it is safe.
1175
c906108c
SS
1176If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1177device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1178(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1179
6d2ebf8b 1180@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1181@section Shell commands
1182
1183If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1184debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1185just use the @code{shell} command.
1186
1187@table @code
1188@kindex shell
1189@cindex shell escape
1190@item shell @var{command string}
1191Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1192If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1193shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1194(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1195@end table
1196
1197The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1198You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1199@value{GDBN}:
1200
1201@table @code
1202@kindex make
1203@cindex calling make
1204@item make @var{make-args}
1205Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1206arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1207@end table
1208
6d2ebf8b 1209@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1210@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1211
1212You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1213name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1214@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1215key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1216show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1217
1218@menu
1219* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1220* Completion:: Command completion
1221* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1222@end menu
1223
6d2ebf8b 1224@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1225@section Command syntax
1226
1227A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1228how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1229arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1230command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1231step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1232with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1233
1234@cindex abbreviation
1235@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1236unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1237documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1238abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1239equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1240names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1241arguments to the @code{help} command.
1242
1243@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1244@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1245A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1246repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1247will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1248repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1249repeat.
1250
1251The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1252@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1253exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1254
1255@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1256output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1257(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1258@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1259repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1260
41afff9a 1261@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1262@cindex comment
1263Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1264nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1265Files,,Command files}).
1266
88118b3a
TT
1267@cindex repeating command sequences
1268@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1269The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1270commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1271then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1272for editing.
1273
6d2ebf8b 1274@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1275@section Command completion
1276
1277@cindex completion
1278@cindex word completion
1279@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1280only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1281are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1282commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1283
1284Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1285of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1286word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1287enter it). For example, if you type
1288
1289@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1290@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1291@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1292@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1293@smallexample
c906108c 1294(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1295@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1296
1297@noindent
1298@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1299the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1300
474c8240 1301@smallexample
c906108c 1302(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1303@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1304
1305@noindent
1306You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1307breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1308@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1309were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1310might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1311to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1312
1313If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1314@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1315characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1316@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1317example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1318begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1319just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1320function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1321example:
1322
474c8240 1323@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1324(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1325@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1326make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1327make_abs_section make_function_type
1328make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1329make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1330make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1331(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1332@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1333
1334@noindent
1335After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1336partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1337command.
1338
1339If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1340can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1341means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1342key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1343one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1344
1345@cindex quotes in commands
1346@cindex completion of quoted strings
1347Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1348parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1349its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1350situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1351@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1352
c906108c 1353The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1354name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1355overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1356by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1357may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1358that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1359that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1360word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1361@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1362@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1363when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1364
474c8240 1365@smallexample
96a2c332 1366(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1367bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1368(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1369@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1370
1371In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1372quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1373completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1374place:
1375
474c8240 1376@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1377(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1378@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1379(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1380@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1381
1382@noindent
1383In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1384you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1385completion on an overloaded symbol.
1386
d4f3574e 1387For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1388expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1389overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1390see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1391
1392
6d2ebf8b 1393@node Help
c906108c
SS
1394@section Getting help
1395@cindex online documentation
1396@kindex help
1397
5d161b24 1398You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1399using the command @code{help}.
1400
1401@table @code
41afff9a 1402@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1403@item help
1404@itemx h
1405You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1406display a short list of named classes of commands:
1407
1408@smallexample
1409(@value{GDBP}) help
1410List of classes of commands:
1411
2df3850c 1412aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1413breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1414data -- Examining data
c906108c 1415files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1416internals -- Maintenance commands
1417obscure -- Obscure features
1418running -- Running the program
1419stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1420status -- Status inquiries
1421support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1422tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1423 stopping the program
c906108c 1424user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1425
5d161b24 1426Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1427commands in that class.
5d161b24 1428Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1429documentation.
1430Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1431(@value{GDBP})
1432@end smallexample
96a2c332 1433@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1434
1435@item help @var{class}
1436Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1437list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1438help display for the class @code{status}:
1439
1440@smallexample
1441(@value{GDBP}) help status
1442Status inquiries.
1443
1444List of commands:
1445
1446@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1447@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1448info -- Generic command for showing things
1449 about the program being debugged
1450show -- Generic command for showing things
1451 about the debugger
c906108c 1452
5d161b24 1453Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1454documentation.
1455Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1456(@value{GDBP})
1457@end smallexample
1458
1459@item help @var{command}
1460With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1461short paragraph on how to use that command.
1462
6837a0a2
DB
1463@kindex apropos
1464@item apropos @var{args}
1465The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1466commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1467@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1468
1469@smallexample
1470apropos reload
1471@end smallexample
1472
b37052ae
EZ
1473@noindent
1474results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1475
1476@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1477@c @group
1478set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1479 multiple times in one run
1480show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1481 multiple times in one run
1482@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1483@end smallexample
1484
c906108c
SS
1485@kindex complete
1486@item complete @var{args}
1487The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1488for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1489command you want completed. For example:
1490
1491@smallexample
1492complete i
1493@end smallexample
1494
1495@noindent results in:
1496
1497@smallexample
1498@group
2df3850c
JM
1499if
1500ignore
c906108c
SS
1501info
1502inspect
c906108c
SS
1503@end group
1504@end smallexample
1505
1506@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1507@end table
1508
1509In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1510and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1511of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1512manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1513under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1514all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1515
1516@c @group
1517@table @code
1518@kindex info
41afff9a 1519@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1520@item info
1521This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1522program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1523with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1524registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1525You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1526@w{@code{help info}}.
1527
1528@kindex set
1529@item set
5d161b24 1530You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1531@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1532@code{set prompt $}.
1533
1534@kindex show
1535@item show
5d161b24 1536In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1537@value{GDBN} itself.
1538You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1539related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1540system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1541which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1542
1543@kindex info set
1544To display all the settable parameters and their current
1545values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1546@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1547@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1548@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1549@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1550@end table
1551@c @end group
1552
1553Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1554exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1555
1556@table @code
1557@kindex show version
1558@cindex version number
1559@item show version
1560Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1561information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1562@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1563version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1564commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1565system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1566variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1567The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1568@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1569
1570@kindex show copying
1571@item show copying
1572Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1573
1574@kindex show warranty
1575@item show warranty
2df3850c 1576Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1577if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1578
c906108c
SS
1579@end table
1580
6d2ebf8b 1581@node Running
c906108c
SS
1582@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1583
1584When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1585debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1586
1587You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1588of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1589your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1590kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1591
1592@menu
1593* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1594* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1595* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1596* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1597
1598* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1599* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1600* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1601* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1602
1603* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1604* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1605@end menu
1606
6d2ebf8b 1607@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1608@section Compiling for debugging
1609
1610In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1611debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1612is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1613variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1614and addresses in the executable code.
1615
1616To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1617the compiler.
1618
e2e0bcd1
JB
1619Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1620the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1621because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1622the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1623options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1624debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1625``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1626to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1627@option{-g} alone.
1628
c906108c
SS
1629Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1630options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1631executables containing debugging information.
1632
53a5351d
JM
1633@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1634without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1635recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1636program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1637in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1638
1639@cindex optimized code, debugging
1640@cindex debugging optimized code
1641When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1642optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1643really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1644exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1645variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1646variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1647
1648Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1649@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1650doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1651please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1652
1653Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1654@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1655format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1656
1657@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1658@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1659@section Starting your program
1660@cindex starting
1661@cindex running
1662
1663@table @code
1664@kindex run
41afff9a 1665@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1666@item run
1667@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1668Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1669You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1670argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1671@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1672(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1673
1674@end table
1675
c906108c
SS
1676If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1677supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1678that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1679@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1680
1681The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1682receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1683information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1684can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1685your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1686divided into four categories:
1687
1688@table @asis
1689@item The @emph{arguments.}
1690Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1691@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1692is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1693(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1694the arguments.
1695In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1696@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1697@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1698
1699@item The @emph{environment.}
1700Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1701use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1702environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1703your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1704
1705@item The @emph{working directory.}
1706Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1707the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1708@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1709
1710@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1711Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1712standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1713in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1714set a different device for your program.
1715@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1716
1717@cindex pipes
1718@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1719pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1720program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1721wrong program.
1722@end table
c906108c
SS
1723
1724When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1725immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1726of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1727stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1728or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1729
1730If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1731time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1732table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1733your current breakpoints.
1734
6d2ebf8b 1735@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1736@section Your program's arguments
1737
1738@cindex arguments (to your program)
1739The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1740@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1741They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1742performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1743@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1744@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1745the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1746
1747On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1748@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1749calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1750the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1751
1752@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1753@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1754
c906108c 1755@table @code
41afff9a 1756@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1757@item set args
1758Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1759@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1760with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1761using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1762it again without arguments.
1763
1764@kindex show args
1765@item show args
1766Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1767@end table
1768
6d2ebf8b 1769@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1770@section Your program's environment
1771
1772@cindex environment (of your program)
1773The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1774their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1775your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1776path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1777the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1778debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1779environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1780
1781@table @code
1782@kindex path
1783@item path @var{directory}
1784Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1785(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1786The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1787You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1788system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1789MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1790is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1791
1792You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1793working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1794use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1795@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1796@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1797@var{directory} to the search path.
1798@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1799@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1800
1801@kindex show paths
1802@item show paths
1803Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1804environment variable).
1805
1806@kindex show environment
1807@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1808Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1809your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1810print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1811your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1812
1813@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1814@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1815Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1816changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1817be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1818any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1819parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1820null value.
1821@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1822@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1823
1824For example, this command:
1825
474c8240 1826@smallexample
c906108c 1827set env USER = foo
474c8240 1828@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1829
1830@noindent
d4f3574e 1831tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1832@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1833are not actually required.)
1834
1835@kindex unset environment
1836@item unset environment @var{varname}
1837Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1838program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1839@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1840rather than assigning it an empty value.
1841@end table
1842
d4f3574e
SS
1843@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1844the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1845by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1846@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1847that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1848@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1849your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1850files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1851@file{.profile}.
1852
6d2ebf8b 1853@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1854@section Your program's working directory
1855
1856@cindex working directory (of your program)
1857Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1858working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1859The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1860from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1861working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1862
1863The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1864that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1865specify files}.
1866
1867@table @code
1868@kindex cd
1869@item cd @var{directory}
1870Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1871
1872@kindex pwd
1873@item pwd
1874Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1875@end table
1876
6d2ebf8b 1877@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1878@section Your program's input and output
1879
1880@cindex redirection
1881@cindex i/o
1882@cindex terminal
1883By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1884the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1885to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1886modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1887running your program.
1888
1889@table @code
1890@kindex info terminal
1891@item info terminal
1892Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1893program is using.
1894@end table
1895
1896You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1897redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1898
474c8240 1899@smallexample
c906108c 1900run > outfile
474c8240 1901@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1902
1903@noindent
1904starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1905
1906@kindex tty
1907@cindex controlling terminal
1908Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1909with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1910argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1911commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1912process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1913
474c8240 1914@smallexample
c906108c 1915tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1916@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1917
1918@noindent
1919directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1920default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1921that as their controlling terminal.
1922
1923An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1924effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1925terminal.
1926
1927When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1928command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1929for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1930
6d2ebf8b 1931@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1932@section Debugging an already-running process
1933@kindex attach
1934@cindex attach
1935
1936@table @code
1937@item attach @var{process-id}
1938This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1939outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1940targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1941find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1942or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1943
1944@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1945executing the command.
1946@end table
1947
1948To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1949which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1950programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1951also have permission to send the process a signal.
1952
1953When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1954the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1955the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1956(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1957the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1958Specify Files}.
1959
1960The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1961process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1962with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1963you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1964can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1965process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1966attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1967
1968@table @code
1969@kindex detach
1970@item detach
1971When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1972@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1973the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1974that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1975are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1976@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1977executing the command.
1978@end table
1979
1980If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1981attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1982for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1983control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1984confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1985messages}).
1986
6d2ebf8b 1987@node Kill Process
c906108c 1988@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1989
1990@table @code
1991@kindex kill
1992@item kill
1993Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1994@end table
1995
1996This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1997running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1998is running.
1999
2000On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2001while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2002@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2003outside the debugger.
2004
2005The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2006relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2007executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2008next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2009reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2010breakpoint settings).
2011
6d2ebf8b 2012@node Threads
c906108c 2013@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2014
2015@cindex threads of execution
2016@cindex multiple threads
2017@cindex switching threads
2018In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2019may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2020of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2021the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2022that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2023modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2024registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2025
2026@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2027programs:
2028
2029@itemize @bullet
2030@item automatic notification of new threads
2031@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2032@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2033@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2034a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2035@item thread-specific breakpoints
2036@end itemize
2037
c906108c
SS
2038@quotation
2039@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2040@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2041If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2042effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2043from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2044like this:
2045
2046@smallexample
2047(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2048(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2049Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2050see the IDs of currently known threads.
2051@end smallexample
2052@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2053@c doesn't support threads"?
2054@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2055
2056@cindex focus of debugging
2057@cindex current thread
2058The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2059threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2060control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2061This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2062program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2063
41afff9a 2064@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2065@cindex thread identifier (system)
2066@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2067@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2068@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2069Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2070the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2071form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2072whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2073LynxOS, you might see
2074
474c8240 2075@smallexample
c906108c 2076[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2077@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2078
2079@noindent
2080when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2081the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2082further qualifier.
2083
2084@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2085@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2086@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2087@c program?
2088@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2089@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2090@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2091
2092@cindex thread number
2093@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2094For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2095number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2096
2097@table @code
2098@kindex info threads
2099@item info threads
2100Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2101program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2102
2103@enumerate
2104@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2105
2106@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2107
2108@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2109@end enumerate
2110
2111@noindent
2112An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2113indicates the current thread.
2114
5d161b24 2115For example,
c906108c
SS
2116@end table
2117@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2118
2119@smallexample
2120(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2121 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2122 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2124 at threadtest.c:68
2125@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2126
2127On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2128
2129@cindex thread number
2130@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2131For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2132number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2133thread in your program.
2134
41afff9a
EZ
2135@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2136@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2137@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2138@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2139@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2140Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2141both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2142form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2143whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2144HP-UX, you see
2145
474c8240 2146@smallexample
c906108c 2147[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2148@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2149
2150@noindent
5d161b24 2151when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2152
2153@table @code
2154@kindex info threads
2155@item info threads
2156Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2157program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2158
2159@enumerate
2160@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2161
2162@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2163
2164@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2165@end enumerate
2166
2167@noindent
2168An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2169indicates the current thread.
2170
5d161b24 2171For example,
c906108c
SS
2172@end table
2173@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2174
474c8240 2175@smallexample
c906108c 2176(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2177 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2178 at quicksort.c:137
2179 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2180 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2181 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2182 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2183@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2184
2185@table @code
2186@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2187@item thread @var{threadno}
2188Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2189argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2190shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2191@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2192you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2193
2194@smallexample
2195@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2196(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2197[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21980x34e5 in sigpause ()
2199@end smallexample
2200
2201@noindent
2202As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2203@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2204threads.
c906108c
SS
2205
2206@kindex thread apply
2207@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2208The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2209more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2210with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2211@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2212threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2213@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2214@end table
2215
2216@cindex automatic thread selection
2217@cindex switching threads automatically
2218@cindex threads, automatic switching
2219Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2220signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2221signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2222message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2223thread.
2224
2225@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2226more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2227programs with multiple threads.
2228
2229@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2230watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2231
6d2ebf8b 2232@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2233@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2234
2235@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2236@cindex multiple processes
2237@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2238On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2239programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2240function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2241parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2242set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2243will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2244will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2245
2246However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2247which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2248the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2249only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2250so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2251on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2252get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2253@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2254the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2255the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2256
53a5351d
JM
2257On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2258debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2259@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2260
2261By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2262the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2263
2264If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2265use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2266
2267@table @code
2268@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2269@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2270Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2271@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2272process. The @var{mode} can be:
2273
2274@table @code
2275@item parent
2276The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2277unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2278
2279@item child
2280The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2281unimpeded.
2282
2283@item ask
2284The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2285@end table
2286
2287@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2288Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2289@end table
2290
2291If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2292@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2293breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2294@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2295the child process's @code{main}.
2296
2297When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2298child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2299
2300If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2301call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2302use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2303argument.
2304
2305You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2306a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2307Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2308
6d2ebf8b 2309@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2310@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2311
2312The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2313program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2314trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2315
7a292a7a
SS
2316Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2317such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2318@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2319change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2320continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2321ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2322explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2323
2324@table @code
2325@kindex info program
2326@item info program
2327Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2328running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2329@end table
2330
2331@menu
2332* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2333* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2334* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2335* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2336@end menu
2337
6d2ebf8b 2338@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2339@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2340
2341@cindex breakpoints
2342A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2343the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2344control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2345breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2346Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2347should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2348program.
2349
2350In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2351breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2352a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2353is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2354not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2355arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2356
2357@cindex watchpoints
2358@cindex memory tracing
2359@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2360@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2361A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2362when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2363command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2364watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2365any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2366and watchpoints using the same commands.
2367
2368You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2369whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2370Automatic display}.
2371
2372@cindex catchpoints
2373@cindex breakpoint on events
2374A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2375when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2376exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2377different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2378catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2379other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2380@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2381
2382@cindex breakpoint numbers
2383@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2384@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2385catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2386starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2387features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2388breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2389@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2390enable it again.
2391
c5394b80
JM
2392@cindex breakpoint ranges
2393@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2394Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2395operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2396@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2397hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2398all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2399
c906108c
SS
2400@menu
2401* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2402* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2403* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2404* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2405* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2406* Conditions:: Break conditions
2407* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2408* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2409* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2410@end menu
2411
6d2ebf8b 2412@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2413@subsection Setting breakpoints
2414
5d161b24 2415@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2416@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2417@c
2418@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2419
2420@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2421@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2422@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2423@cindex latest breakpoint
2424Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2425@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2426number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2427Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2428convenience variables.
2429
2430You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2431
2432@table @code
2433@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2434Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2435When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2436C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2437@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2438
2439@item break +@var{offset}
2440@itemx break -@var{offset}
2441Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2442at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2443(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2444
2445@item break @var{linenum}
2446Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2447The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2448The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2449code on that line.
2450
2451@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2452Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2453
2454@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2455Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2456@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2457superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2458functions.
2459
2460@item break *@var{address}
2461Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2462breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2463information or source files.
2464
2465@item break
2466When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2467the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2468(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2469innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2470returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2471@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2472that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2473@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2474the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2475inside loops.
2476
2477@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2478least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2479would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2480breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2481existed when your program stopped.
2482
2483@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2484Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2485@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2486value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2487@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2488above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2489,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2490
2491@kindex tbreak
2492@item tbreak @var{args}
2493Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2494same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2495way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2496program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2497
c906108c
SS
2498@kindex hbreak
2499@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2500Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2501@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2502breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2503have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2504debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2505changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2506provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2507will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2508address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2509breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2510example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2511@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2512or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2513(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
501eef12
AC
2514@xref{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2515
c906108c
SS
2516
2517@kindex thbreak
2518@item thbreak @var{args}
2519Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2520are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2521the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2522the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2523first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2524command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2525may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2526See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2527
2528@kindex rbreak
2529@cindex regular expression
2530@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2531Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2532@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2533matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2534breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2535the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2536them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2537
2538The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2539like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2540shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2541an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2542@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2543match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2544
b37052ae 2545When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2546breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2547classes.
c906108c
SS
2548
2549@kindex info breakpoints
2550@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2551@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2554Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2555not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2556
2557@table @emph
2558@item Breakpoint Numbers
2559@item Type
2560Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2561@item Disposition
2562Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2563@item Enabled or Disabled
2564Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2565that are not enabled.
2566@item Address
2df3850c 2567Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2568@item What
2569Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2570line number.
2571@end table
2572
2573@noindent
2574If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2575the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2576are listed after that.
2577
2578@noindent
2579@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2580number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2581convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2582the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2583listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2584
2585@noindent
2586@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2587has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2588@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2589hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2590was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2591will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2592@end table
2593
2594@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2595your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2596the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2597(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2598
2599@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2600@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2601@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2602special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2603programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2604starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2605You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2606@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2607
2608
6d2ebf8b 2609@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2610@subsection Setting watchpoints
2611
2612@cindex setting watchpoints
2613@cindex software watchpoints
2614@cindex hardware watchpoints
2615You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2616expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2617this may happen.
2618
2619Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2620hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2621program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2622times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2623catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2624culprit.)
2625
1104b9e7 2626On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2627@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2628hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2629program.
2630
2631@table @code
2632@kindex watch
2633@item watch @var{expr}
2634Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2635is written into by the program and its value changes.
2636
2637@kindex rwatch
2638@item rwatch @var{expr}
2639Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2640
2641@kindex awatch
2642@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2643Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2644by the program.
c906108c
SS
2645
2646@kindex info watchpoints
2647@item info watchpoints
2648This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2649it is the same as @code{info break}.
2650@end table
2651
2652@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2653watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2654value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2655cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2656executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2657statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2658
2659When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2660
474c8240 2661@smallexample
c906108c 2662Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2663@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2664
2665@noindent
2666if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2667
7be570e7
JM
2668Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2669hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2670value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2671every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2672that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2673hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2674will print a message like this:
2675
2676@smallexample
2677Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2678@end smallexample
2679
2680Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2681data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2682watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2683can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2684cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2685double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2686wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2687into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2688
2689If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2690to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2691Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2692time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2693able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2694warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2695
2696@smallexample
2697Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2698@end smallexample
2699
2700@noindent
2701If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2702
2703The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2704or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2705data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2706hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2707both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2708watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2709@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2710watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2711@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2712Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2713
2714If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2715any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2716kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2717
7be570e7
JM
2718@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2719(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2720they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2721which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2722being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2723and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2724rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2725way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2726@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2727
c906108c
SS
2728@quotation
2729@cindex watchpoints and threads
2730@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2731@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2732usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2733can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2734you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2735thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2736can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2737@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2738the expression.
53a5351d 2739
d4f3574e 2740@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2741@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2742have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2743watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2744single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2745change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2746confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2747software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2748when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2749watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2750@end quotation
c906108c 2751
501eef12
AC
2752@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
2753
6d2ebf8b 2754@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2755@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2756@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2757@cindex exception handlers
2758@cindex event handling
2759
2760You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2761kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2762shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2763
2764@table @code
2765@kindex catch
2766@item catch @var{event}
2767Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2768@table @code
2769@item throw
2770@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2771The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2772
2773@item catch
2774@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2775The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2776
2777@item exec
2778@kindex catch exec
2779A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2780
2781@item fork
2782@kindex catch fork
2783A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2784
2785@item vfork
2786@kindex catch vfork
2787A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2788
2789@item load
2790@itemx load @var{libname}
2791@kindex catch load
2792The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2793@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2794
2795@item unload
2796@itemx unload @var{libname}
2797@kindex catch unload
2798The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2799of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2800@end table
2801
2802@item tcatch @var{event}
2803Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2804automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2805
2806@end table
2807
2808Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2809
b37052ae 2810There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2811(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2812
2813@itemize @bullet
2814@item
2815If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2816control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2817raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2818returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2819simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2820that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2821you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2822disabled within interactive calls.
2823
2824@item
2825You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2826
2827@item
2828You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2829@end itemize
2830
2831@cindex raise exceptions
2832Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2833if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2834stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2835can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2836breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2837out where the exception was raised.
2838
2839To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2840knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2841raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2842which has the following ANSI C interface:
2843
474c8240 2844@smallexample
c906108c 2845 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2846 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2847 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2848@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2849
2850@noindent
2851To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2852unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2853(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2854
2855With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2856that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2857a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2858breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2859raised.
2860
2861
6d2ebf8b 2862@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2863@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2864
2865@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2866@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2867It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2868catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2869to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2870breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2871
2872With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2873where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2874delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2875their breakpoint numbers.
2876
2877It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2878automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2879when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2880
2881@table @code
2882@kindex clear
2883@item clear
2884Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2885selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2886the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2887breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2888
2889@item clear @var{function}
2890@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2891Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2892
2893@item clear @var{linenum}
2894@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2895Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2896
2897@cindex delete breakpoints
2898@kindex delete
41afff9a 2899@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2900@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2901Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2902ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2903breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2904confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2905@end table
2906
6d2ebf8b 2907@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2908@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2909
2910@kindex disable breakpoints
2911@kindex enable breakpoints
2912Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2913prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2914it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2915that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2916
2917You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2918the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2919or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2920@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2921catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2922
2923A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2924states of enablement:
2925
2926@itemize @bullet
2927@item
2928Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2929with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2930@item
2931Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2932@item
2933Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2934disabled.
c906108c
SS
2935@item
2936Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2937immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2938set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2939@end itemize
2940
2941You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2942watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2943
2944@table @code
2945@kindex disable breakpoints
2946@kindex disable
41afff9a 2947@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2948@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2949Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2950listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2951options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2952case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2953@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2954
2955@kindex enable breakpoints
2956@kindex enable
c5394b80 2957@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2958Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2959become effective once again in stopping your program.
2960
c5394b80 2961@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2962Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2963of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2964
c5394b80 2965@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2966Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2967deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2968@end table
2969
d4f3574e
SS
2970@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2971@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2972Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2973,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2974subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2975the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2976breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2977breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2978stepping}.)
2979
6d2ebf8b 2980@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2981@subsection Break conditions
2982@cindex conditional breakpoints
2983@cindex breakpoint conditions
2984
2985@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2986@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2987The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2988specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2989breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2990programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2991a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2992and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2993
2994This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2995situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2996when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2997by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2998@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2999
3000Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3001since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3002it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3003and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3004one.
3005
3006Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3007your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3008that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3009format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3010unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3011that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3012program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3013breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3014conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3015purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3016(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3017
3018Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3019@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3020Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3021with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3022
c906108c
SS
3023You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3024The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3025@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3026catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3027
3028@table @code
3029@kindex condition
3030@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3031Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3032watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3033breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3034@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3035@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3036syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3037referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3038symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3039prints an error message:
3040
474c8240 3041@smallexample
d4f3574e 3042No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3043@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3044
3045@noindent
c906108c
SS
3046@value{GDBN} does
3047not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3048command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3049@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3050
3051@item condition @var{bnum}
3052Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3053an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3054@end table
3055
3056@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3057A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3058breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3059useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3060count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3061is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3062therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3063ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3064the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3065value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3066your program reaches it.
3067
3068@table @code
3069@kindex ignore
3070@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3071Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3072The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3073execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3074takes no action.
3075
3076To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3077a count of zero.
3078
3079When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3080breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3081@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3082Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3083
3084If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3085condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3086@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3087
3088You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3089as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3090is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3091variables}.
3092@end table
3093
3094Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3095
3096
6d2ebf8b 3097@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3098@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3099
3100@cindex breakpoint commands
3101You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3102commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3103example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3104enable other breakpoints.
3105
3106@table @code
3107@kindex commands
3108@kindex end
3109@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3110@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3111@itemx end
3112Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3113themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3114@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3115
3116To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3117follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3118
3119With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3120breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3121recently encountered).
3122@end table
3123
3124Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3125disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3126
3127You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3128use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3129that resumes execution.
3130
3131Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3132execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3133(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3134another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3135ambiguities about which list to execute.
3136
3137@kindex silent
3138If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3139usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3140be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3141then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3142see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3143meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3144
3145The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3146print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3147breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3148
3149For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3150value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3151
474c8240 3152@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3153break foo if x>0
3154commands
3155silent
3156printf "x is %d\n",x
3157cont
3158end
474c8240 3159@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3160
3161One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3162you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3163of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3164erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3165to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3166so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3167command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3168
474c8240 3169@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3170break 403
3171commands
3172silent
3173set x = y + 4
3174cont
3175end
474c8240 3176@end smallexample
c906108c 3177
6d2ebf8b 3178@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3179@subsection Breakpoint menus
3180@cindex overloading
3181@cindex symbol overloading
3182
b37052ae 3183Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3184to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3185This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3186@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3187a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3188something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3189particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3190you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3191waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3192options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3193sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3194@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3195breakpoints.
3196
3197For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3198breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3199We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3200
3201@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3202@smallexample
3203@group
3204(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3205[0] cancel
3206[1] all
3207[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3208[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3209[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3210[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3211[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3212[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3213> 2 4 6
3214Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3215Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3216Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3217Multiple breakpoints were set.
3218Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3219 breakpoints.
3220(@value{GDBP})
3221@end group
3222@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3223
3224@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3225@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3226@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3227@c
3228@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3229@c
d4f3574e
SS
3230Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3231any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3232attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3233@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3234
474c8240 3235@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3236Cannot insert breakpoints.
3237The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3238@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3239
3240When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3241
3242@enumerate
3243@item
3244Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3245
3246@item
5d161b24 3247Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3248name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3249that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3250Then start your program again.
3251
3252@item
3253Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3254linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3255to nonsharable executables.
3256@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3257@c @end ifclear
3258
d4f3574e
SS
3259A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3260hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3261
3262@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3263@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3264@smallexample
3265Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3266You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3267@end smallexample
3268
3269@noindent
3270This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3271only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3272watchpoints it needs to insert.
3273
3274When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3275hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3276
3277
6d2ebf8b 3278@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3279@section Continuing and stepping
3280
3281@cindex stepping
3282@cindex continuing
3283@cindex resuming execution
3284@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3285completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3286one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3287line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3288particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3289your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3290it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3291@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3292
3293@table @code
3294@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3295@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3296@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3297@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3298@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3299@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3300Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3301any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3302@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3303ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3304@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3305
3306The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3307stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3308@code{continue} is ignored.
3309
d4f3574e
SS
3310The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3311debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3312purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3313@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3314@end table
3315
3316To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3317(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3318calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3319different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3320
3321A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3322(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3323beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3324is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3325and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3326interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3327
3328@table @code
3329@kindex step
41afff9a 3330@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3331@item step
3332Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3333line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3334abbreviated @code{s}.
3335
3336@quotation
3337@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3338@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3339@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3340@c distinction here.
3341@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3342within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3343execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3344debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3345is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3346without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3347below.
3348@end quotation
3349
4a92d011
EZ
3350The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3351line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3352@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3353to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3354the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3355called within the line.
c906108c 3356
d4f3574e
SS
3357Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3358number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3359@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3360on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3361was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3362
3363@item step @var{count}
3364Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3365breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3366@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3367
3368@kindex next
41afff9a 3369@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3370@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3371Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3372This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3373the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3374control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3375that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3376is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3377
3378An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3379
3380
3381@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3382@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3383@c
3384@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3385@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3386@c function are executed without stopping.
3387
d4f3574e
SS
3388The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3389source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3390@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3391
b90a5f51
CF
3392@kindex set step-mode
3393@item set step-mode
3394@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3395@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3396@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3397The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3398stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3399information rather than stepping over it.
3400
4a92d011
EZ
3401This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3402machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3403want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3404
3405@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3406Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3407debug information. This is the default.
3408
c906108c
SS
3409@kindex finish
3410@item finish
3411Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3412returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3413
3414Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3415,Returning from a function}).
3416
3417@kindex until
41afff9a 3418@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3419@item until
3420@itemx u
3421Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3422current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3423stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3424command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3425automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3426than the address of the jump.
3427
3428This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3429though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3430exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3431simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3432through the next iteration.
3433
3434@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3435stack frame.
3436
3437@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3438of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3439example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3440(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3441@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3442
474c8240 3443@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3444(@value{GDBP}) f
3445#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3446206 expand_input();
3447(@value{GDBP}) until
3448195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3449@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3450
3451This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3452generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3453start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3454written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3455to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3456expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3457statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3458
3459@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3460instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3461argument.
3462
3463@item until @var{location}
3464@itemx u @var{location}
3465Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3466reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3467the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
c60eb6f1
EZ
3468,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3469hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3470location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3471implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3472invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3473line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3474line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3475invocations have returned.
3476
3477@smallexample
347894 int factorial (int value)
347995 @{
348096 if (value > 1) @{
348197 value *= factorial (value - 1);
348298 @}
348399 return (value);
3484100 @}
3485@end smallexample
3486
3487
3488@kindex advance @var{location}
3489@itemx advance @var{location}
3490Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3491required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3492command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3493frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3494not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3495have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3496
c906108c
SS
3497
3498@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3499@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3500@item stepi
96a2c332 3501@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3502@itemx si
3503Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3504
3505It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3506instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3507instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3508Display,, Automatic display}.
3509
3510An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3511
3512@need 750
3513@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3514@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3515@item nexti
96a2c332 3516@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3517@itemx ni
3518Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3519proceed until the function returns.
3520
3521An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3522@end table
3523
6d2ebf8b 3524@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3525@section Signals
3526@cindex signals
3527
3528A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3529operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3530kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3531signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3532@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3533memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3534the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3535requested an alarm).
3536
3537@cindex fatal signals
3538Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3539functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3540errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3541program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3542@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3543fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3544
3545@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3546program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3547signal.
3548
3549@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3550Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3551@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3552(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3553but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3554You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3555
3556@table @code
3557@kindex info signals
3558@item info signals
96a2c332 3559@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3560Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3561handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3562the defined types of signals.
3563
d4f3574e 3564@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3565
3566@kindex handle
3567@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3568Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3569can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3570@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3571@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3572known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3573@end table
3574
3575@c @group
3576The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3577Their full names are:
3578
3579@table @code
3580@item nostop
3581@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3582still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3583
3584@item stop
3585@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3586the @code{print} keyword as well.
3587
3588@item print
3589@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3590
3591@item noprint
3592@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3593implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3594
3595@item pass
5ece1a18 3596@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3597@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3598can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3599and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3600
3601@item nopass
5ece1a18 3602@itemx ignore
c906108c 3603@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3604@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3605@end table
3606@c @end group
3607
d4f3574e
SS
3608When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3609program until you
c906108c
SS
3610continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3611effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3612after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3613command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3614program sees that signal when you continue.
3615
24f93129
EZ
3616The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3617non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3618@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3619erroneous signals.
3620
c906108c
SS
3621You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3622seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3623or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3624due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3625values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3626execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3627a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3628you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3629program a signal}.
c906108c 3630
6d2ebf8b 3631@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3632@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3633
3634When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3635programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3636breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3637
3638@table @code
3639@cindex breakpoints and threads
3640@cindex thread breakpoints
3641@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3642@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3643@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3644@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3645writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3646
3647Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3648to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3649particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3650numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3651column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3652
3653If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3654breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3655program.
3656
3657You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3658well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3659breakpoint condition, like this:
3660
3661@smallexample
2df3850c 3662(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3663@end smallexample
3664
3665@end table
3666
3667@cindex stopped threads
3668@cindex threads, stopped
3669Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3670@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3671allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3672switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3673underfoot.
3674
3675@cindex continuing threads
3676@cindex threads, continuing
3677Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3678executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3679like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3680
3681In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3682Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3683system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3684execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3685single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3686statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3687stops.
3688
3689You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3690continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3691thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3692first thread completes whatever you requested.
3693
3694On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3695thread to run.
3696
3697@table @code
3698@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3699Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3700locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3701current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3702mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3703``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3704stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3705when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3706function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3707like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3708thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3709@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3710
3711@item show scheduler-locking
3712Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3713@end table
3714
c906108c 3715
6d2ebf8b 3716@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3717@chapter Examining the Stack
3718
3719When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3720stopped and how it got there.
3721
3722@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3723Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3724is generated.
3725That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3726the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3727and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3728The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3729The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3730stack}.
3731
3732When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3733stack allow you to see all of this information.
3734
3735@cindex selected frame
3736One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3737@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3738particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3739your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3740special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3741interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3742
3743When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3744currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3745@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3746
3747@menu
3748* Frames:: Stack frames
3749* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3750* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3751* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3752
3753@end menu
3754
6d2ebf8b 3755@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3756@section Stack frames
3757
d4f3574e 3758@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3759@cindex stack frame
3760The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3761frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3762with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3763to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3764which the function is executing.
3765
3766@cindex initial frame
3767@cindex outermost frame
3768@cindex innermost frame
3769When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3770function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3771@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3772made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3773is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3774the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3775actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3776recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3777
3778@cindex frame pointer
3779Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3780stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3781kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3782address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3783in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3784going on in that frame.
3785
3786@cindex frame number
3787@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3788zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3789and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3790they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3791frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3792
6d2ebf8b
SS
3793@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3794@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3795@cindex frameless execution
3796Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3797without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3798@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3799@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3800@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3801generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3802This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3803the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3804with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3805has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3806it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3807correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3808no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3809
3810@table @code
d4f3574e 3811@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3812@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3813@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3814The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3815and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3816address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3817@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3818
3819@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3820@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3821@item select-frame
3822The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3823to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3824@code{frame}.
3825@end table
3826
6d2ebf8b 3827@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3828@section Backtraces
3829
3830@cindex backtraces
3831@cindex tracebacks
3832@cindex stack traces
3833A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3834line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3835frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3836stack.
3837
3838@table @code
3839@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3840@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3841@item backtrace
3842@itemx bt
3843Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3844frames in the stack.
3845
3846You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3847character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3848
3849@item backtrace @var{n}
3850@itemx bt @var{n}
3851Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3852
3853@item backtrace -@var{n}
3854@itemx bt -@var{n}
3855Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3856@end table
3857
3858@kindex where
3859@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3860@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3861The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3862are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3863
3864Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3865The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3866print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3867line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3868counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3869line number.
3870
3871Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3872@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3873
3874@smallexample
3875@group
5d161b24 3876#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3877 at builtin.c:993
3878#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3879#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3880 at macro.c:71
3881(More stack frames follow...)
3882@end group
3883@end smallexample
3884
3885@noindent
3886The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3887value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3888code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3889
b4e9345d
DJ
3890@kindex set backtrace-below-main
3891@kindex show backtrace-below-main
3892
95f90d25
DJ
3893Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3894and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3895When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3896the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3897uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3898change this behavior.
3899
3900@table @code
3901@item set backtrace-below-main off
3902Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3903default.
3904
3905@item set backtrace-below-main
3906@itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3907Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3908
3909@item show backtrace-below-main
3910Display the current backtrace policy.
3911@end table
3912
6d2ebf8b 3913@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3914@section Selecting a frame
3915
3916Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3917whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3918selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3919of the stack frame just selected.
3920
3921@table @code
d4f3574e 3922@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3923@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3924@item frame @var{n}
3925@itemx f @var{n}
3926Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3927(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3928innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3929@code{main}.
3930
3931@item frame @var{addr}
3932@itemx f @var{addr}
3933Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3934chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3935impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3936addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3937switches between them.
3938
c906108c
SS
3939On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3940select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3941
3942On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3943pointer and a program counter.
3944
3945On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3946pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3947@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3948@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3949@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3950
3951@kindex up
3952@item up @var{n}
3953Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3954advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3955that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3956
3957@kindex down
41afff9a 3958@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3959@item down @var{n}
3960Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3961advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3962that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3963abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3964@end table
3965
3966All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3967frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3968arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3969frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3970
3971@need 1000
3972For example:
3973
3974@smallexample
3975@group
3976(@value{GDBP}) up
3977#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3978 at env.c:10
397910 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3980@end group
3981@end smallexample
3982
3983After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3984prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
3985You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3986editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3987@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3988for details.
c906108c
SS
3989
3990@table @code
3991@kindex down-silently
3992@kindex up-silently
3993@item up-silently @var{n}
3994@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3995These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3996respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3997causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3998in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3999distracting.
4000@end table
4001
6d2ebf8b 4002@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
4003@section Information about a frame
4004
4005There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4006stack frame.
4007
4008@table @code
4009@item frame
4010@itemx f
4011When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4012frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4013selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4014argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4015@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4016
4017@kindex info frame
41afff9a 4018@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
4019@item info frame
4020@itemx info f
4021This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4022including:
4023
4024@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
4025@item
4026the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
4027@item
4028the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4029@item
4030the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4031@item
4032the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4033@item
4034the address of the frame's arguments
4035@item
d4f3574e
SS
4036the address of the frame's local variables
4037@item
c906108c
SS
4038the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4039@item
4040which registers were saved in the frame
4041@end itemize
4042
4043@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4044something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4045the usual conventions.
4046
4047@item info frame @var{addr}
4048@itemx info f @var{addr}
4049Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4050selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4051command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4052architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4053@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4054
4055@kindex info args
4056@item info args
4057Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4058
4059@item info locals
4060@kindex info locals
4061Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4062line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4063accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4064
c906108c 4065@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4066@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4067@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4068@item info catch
4069Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4070current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4071exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4072@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4073@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4074
c906108c
SS
4075@end table
4076
c906108c 4077
6d2ebf8b 4078@node Source
c906108c
SS
4079@chapter Examining Source Files
4080
4081@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4082information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4083used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4084the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4085(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4086execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4087source files by explicit command.
4088
7a292a7a 4089If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4090prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4091@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4092
4093@menu
4094* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4095* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4096* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4097* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4098* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4099@end menu
4100
6d2ebf8b 4101@node List
c906108c
SS
4102@section Printing source lines
4103
4104@kindex list
41afff9a 4105@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4106To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4107(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4108There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4109
4110Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4111
4112@table @code
4113@item list @var{linenum}
4114Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4115current source file.
4116
4117@item list @var{function}
4118Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4119@var{function}.
4120
4121@item list
4122Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4123@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4124printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4125as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4126Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4127
4128@item list -
4129Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4130@end table
4131
4132By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4133the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4134
4135@table @code
4136@kindex set listsize
4137@item set listsize @var{count}
4138Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4139the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4140
4141@kindex show listsize
4142@item show listsize
4143Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4144@end table
4145
4146Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4147so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4148than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4149argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4150each repetition moves up in the source file.
4151
4152@cindex linespec
4153In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4154@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4155of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4156Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4157
4158@table @code
4159@item list @var{linespec}
4160Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4161
4162@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4163Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4164linespecs.
4165
4166@item list ,@var{last}
4167Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4168
4169@item list @var{first},
4170Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4171
4172@item list +
4173Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4174
4175@item list -
4176Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4177
4178@item list
4179As described in the preceding table.
4180@end table
4181
4182Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4183kinds of linespec.
4184
4185@table @code
4186@item @var{number}
4187Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4188When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4189the same source file as the first linespec.
4190
4191@item +@var{offset}
4192Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4193When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4194two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4195first linespec.
4196
4197@item -@var{offset}
4198Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4199
4200@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4201Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4202
4203@item @var{function}
4204Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4205For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4206
4207@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4208Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4209function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4210file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4211identically named functions in different source files.
4212
4213@item *@var{address}
4214Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4215@var{address} may be any expression.
4216@end table
4217
87885426
FN
4218@node Edit
4219@section Editing source files
4220@cindex editing source files
4221
4222@kindex edit
4223@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4224To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4225The editing program of your choice
4226is invoked with the current line set to
4227the active line in the program.
4228Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4229want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4230
4231Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4232
4233@table @code
4234@item edit
4235Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4236
4237@item edit @var{number}
4238Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4239
4240@item edit @var{function}
4241Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4242
4243@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4244Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4245
4246@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4247Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4248function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4249file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4250identically named functions in different source files.
4251
4252@item edit *@var{address}
4253Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4254@var{address} may be any expression.
4255@end table
4256
4257@subsection Choosing your editor
4258You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4259@footnote{
4260The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4261following command-line syntax:
10998722 4262@smallexample
87885426 4263ex +@var{number} file
10998722
AC
4264@end smallexample
4265The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4266the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4267by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4268@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4269@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4270@smallexample
87885426
FN
4271EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4272export EDITOR
4273gdb ...
10998722 4274@end smallexample
87885426 4275or in the @code{csh} shell,
10998722 4276@smallexample
87885426
FN
4277setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4278gdb ...
10998722 4279@end smallexample
87885426 4280
6d2ebf8b 4281@node Search
c906108c
SS
4282@section Searching source files
4283@cindex searching
4284@kindex reverse-search
4285
4286There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4287regular expression.
4288
4289@table @code
4290@kindex search
4291@kindex forward-search
4292@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4293@itemx search @var{regexp}
4294The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4295starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4296@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4297synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4298@code{fo}.
4299
4300@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4301The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4302with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4303for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4304this command as @code{rev}.
4305@end table
c906108c 4306
6d2ebf8b 4307@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4308@section Specifying source directories
4309
4310@cindex source path
4311@cindex directories for source files
4312Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4313files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4314the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4315session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4316this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4317it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4318in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4319the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4320the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4321path.
4322
4323If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4324object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4325too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4326compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4327last resort.
4328
4329Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4330any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4331each line is in the file.
4332
4333@kindex directory
4334@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4335When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4336and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4337To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4338
4339@table @code
4340@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4341@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4342Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4343directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4344(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4345part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4346whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4347path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4348
4349@kindex cdir
4350@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4351@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4352@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4353@cindex compilation directory
4354@cindex current directory
4355@cindex working directory
4356@cindex directory, current
4357@cindex directory, compilation
4358You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4359directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4360working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4361tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4362session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4363directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4364
4365@item directory
4366Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4367
4368@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4369@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4370
4371@item show directories
4372@kindex show directories
4373Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4374@end table
4375
4376If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4377interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4378versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4379
4380@enumerate
4381@item
4382Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4383
4384@item
4385Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4386directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4387directories in one command.
4388@end enumerate
4389
6d2ebf8b 4390@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4391@section Source and machine code
4392
4393You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4394addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4395a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4396mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4397line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4398well as hex.
4399
4400@table @code
4401@kindex info line
4402@item info line @var{linespec}
4403Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4404source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4405the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4406source lines}).
4407@end table
4408
4409For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4410the object code for the first line of function
4411@code{m4_changequote}:
4412
d4f3574e
SS
4413@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4414@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4415@smallexample
96a2c332 4416(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4417Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4418@end smallexample
4419
4420@noindent
4421We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4422@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4423@smallexample
4424(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4425Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4426@end smallexample
4427
4428@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4429@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4430After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4431is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4432sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4433,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4434convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4435variables}).
4436
4437@table @code
4438@kindex disassemble
4439@cindex assembly instructions
4440@cindex instructions, assembly
4441@cindex machine instructions
4442@cindex listing machine instructions
4443@item disassemble
4444This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4445instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4446program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4447command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4448surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4449(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4450@end table
4451
c906108c
SS
4452The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4453HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4454
4455@smallexample
4456(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4457Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
44580x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
44590x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
44600x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
44610x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44620x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44630x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44640x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44650x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4466End of assembler dump.
4467@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4468
4469Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4470mnemonics or other syntax.
4471
4472@table @code
d4f3574e 4473@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4474@cindex assembly instructions
4475@cindex instructions, assembly
4476@cindex machine instructions
4477@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4478@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4479@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4480@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4481Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4482program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4483
4484Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4485can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4486The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4487assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4488@end table
4489
4490
6d2ebf8b 4491@node Data
c906108c
SS
4492@chapter Examining Data
4493
4494@cindex printing data
4495@cindex examining data
4496@kindex print
4497@kindex inspect
4498@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4499@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4500@c different window or something like that.
4501The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4502command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4503evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4504program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4505Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4506
4507@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4508@item print @var{expr}
4509@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4510@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4511value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4512you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4513@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4514formats}.
4515
4516@item print
4517@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4518If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4519@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4520conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4521@end table
4522
4523A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4524It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4525specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4526
7a292a7a 4527If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4528fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4529command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4530Table}.
c906108c
SS
4531
4532@menu
4533* Expressions:: Expressions
4534* Variables:: Program variables
4535* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4536* Output Formats:: Output formats
4537* Memory:: Examining memory
4538* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4539* Print Settings:: Print settings
4540* Value History:: Value history
4541* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4542* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4543* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4544* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
29e57380 4545* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4546* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
a0eb71c5
KB
4547* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4548 character set than GDB does
c906108c
SS
4549@end menu
4550
6d2ebf8b 4551@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4552@section Expressions
4553
4554@cindex expressions
4555@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4556compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4557by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4558@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4559casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4560you compiled your program to include this information; see
4561@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4562
d4f3574e
SS
4563@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4564the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4565you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4566memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4567
c906108c
SS
4568Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4569this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4570Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4571languages.
4572
4573In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4574expressions regardless of your programming language.
4575
4576Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4577useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4578at that address in memory.
4579@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4580
4581@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4582to programming languages:
4583
4584@table @code
4585@item @@
4586@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4587@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4588
4589@item ::
4590@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4591function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4592
4593@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4594@cindex type casting memory
4595@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4596@cindex casts, to view memory
4597@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4598Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4599memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4600pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4601a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4602normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4603@end table
4604
6d2ebf8b 4605@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4606@section Program variables
4607
4608The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4609in your program.
4610
4611Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4612(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4613
4614@itemize @bullet
4615@item
4616global (or file-static)
4617@end itemize
4618
5d161b24 4619@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4620
4621@itemize @bullet
4622@item
4623visible according to the scope rules of the
4624programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4625@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4626
4627@noindent This means that in the function
4628
474c8240 4629@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4630foo (a)
4631 int a;
4632@{
4633 bar (a);
4634 @{
4635 int b = test ();
4636 bar (b);
4637 @}
4638@}
474c8240 4639@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4640
4641@noindent
4642you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4643executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4644examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4645the block where @code{b} is declared.
4646
4647@cindex variable name conflict
4648There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4649scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4650in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4651function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4652happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4653you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4654using the colon-colon notation:
4655
d4f3574e 4656@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4657@iftex
4658@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4659@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4660@end iftex
474c8240 4661@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4662@var{file}::@var{variable}
4663@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4664@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4665
4666@noindent
4667Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4668static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4669make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4670to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4671
474c8240 4672@smallexample
c906108c 4673(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4674@end smallexample
c906108c 4675
b37052ae 4676@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4677This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4678use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4679scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4680@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4681@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4682
4683@cindex wrong values
4684@cindex variable values, wrong
4685@quotation
4686@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4687wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4688scope, and just before exit.
4689@end quotation
4690You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4691This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4692set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4693stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4694values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4695also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4696after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4697variable definitions may be gone.
4698
4699This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4700To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4701when compiling.
4702
d4f3574e
SS
4703@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4704Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4705unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4706opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4707offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4708might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4709happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4710
474c8240 4711@smallexample
d4f3574e 4712No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4713@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4714
4715To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4716different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
0179ffac
DC
4717formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler
4718usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
4719produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
4720COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
4721an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
4722for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
d4f3574e
SS
4723
4724
6d2ebf8b 4725@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4726@section Artificial arrays
4727
4728@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4729@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4730It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4731same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4732dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4733program.
4734
4735You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4736@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4737operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4738and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4739of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4740the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4741argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4742following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4743example. If a program says
4744
474c8240 4745@smallexample
c906108c 4746int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4747@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4748
4749@noindent
4750you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4751
474c8240 4752@smallexample
c906108c 4753p *array@@len
474c8240 4754@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4755
4756The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4757with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4758subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4759Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4760(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4761
4762Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4763This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4764The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4765@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4766(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4767$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4768@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4769
4770As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4771@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4772the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4773@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4774(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4775$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4776@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4777
4778Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4779moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4780actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4781of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4782to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4783variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4784interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4785instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4786structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4787in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4788
474c8240 4789@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4790set $i = 0
4791p dtab[$i++]->fv
4792@key{RET}
4793@key{RET}
4794@dots{}
474c8240 4795@end smallexample
c906108c 4796
6d2ebf8b 4797@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4798@section Output formats
4799
4800@cindex formatted output
4801@cindex output formats
4802By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4803this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4804in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4805at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4806these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4807
4808The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4809already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4810@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4811letters supported are:
4812
4813@table @code
4814@item x
4815Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4816hexadecimal.
4817
4818@item d
4819Print as integer in signed decimal.
4820
4821@item u
4822Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4823
4824@item o
4825Print as integer in octal.
4826
4827@item t
4828Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4829@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4830used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4831see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4832
4833@item a
4834@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4835@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4836Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4837the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4838where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4839
474c8240 4840@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4841(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4842$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4843@end smallexample
c906108c 4844
3d67e040
EZ
4845@noindent
4846The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4847@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4848
c906108c
SS
4849@item c
4850Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4851
4852@item f
4853Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4854using typical floating point syntax.
4855@end table
4856
4857For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4858
474c8240 4859@smallexample
c906108c 4860p/x $pc
474c8240 4861@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4862
4863@noindent
4864Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4865names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4866
4867To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4868you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4869expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4870
6d2ebf8b 4871@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4872@section Examining memory
4873
4874You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4875any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4876
4877@cindex examining memory
4878@table @code
41afff9a 4879@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4880@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4881@itemx x @var{addr}
4882@itemx x
4883Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4884@end table
4885
4886@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4887much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4888expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4889If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4890Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4891
4892@table @r
4893@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4894The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4895how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4896@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4897@c 4.1.2.
4898
4899@item @var{f}, the display format
4900The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4901@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4902The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4903The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4904
4905@item @var{u}, the unit size
4906The unit size is any of
4907
4908@table @code
4909@item b
4910Bytes.
4911@item h
4912Halfwords (two bytes).
4913@item w
4914Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4915@item g
4916Giant words (eight bytes).
4917@end table
4918
4919Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4920default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4921@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4922
4923@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4924@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4925memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4926it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4927@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4928@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4929other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4930the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4931starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4932a value from memory).
4933@end table
4934
4935For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4936(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4937starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4938words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4939@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4940
4941Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4942letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4943unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4944specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4945(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4946
4947Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4948and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4949@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4950including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4951alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4952Code,,Source and machine code}.
4953
4954All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4955easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4956you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4957instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4958with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4959the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4960for successive uses of @code{x}.
4961
4962@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4963The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4964in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4965would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4966subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4967@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4968examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4969@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4970the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4971
4972If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4973are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4974address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4975
6d2ebf8b 4976@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4977@section Automatic display
4978@cindex automatic display
4979@cindex display of expressions
4980
4981If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4982(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4983display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4984Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4985to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4986The automatic display looks like this:
4987
474c8240 4988@smallexample
c906108c
SS
49892: foo = 38
49903: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4991@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4992
4993@noindent
4994This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4995displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4996specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4997whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4998format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4999or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5000supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5001
5002@table @code
5003@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
5004@item display @var{expr}
5005Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
5006each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5007
5008@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5009
d4f3574e 5010@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 5011For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 5012count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
5013arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5014@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5015
5016@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5017For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5018number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5019be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5020doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5021@end table
5022
5023For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5024instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 5025is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5026
5027@table @code
5028@kindex delete display
5029@kindex undisplay
5030@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5031@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5032Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5033
5034@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5035(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5036
5037@kindex disable display
5038@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5039Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5040item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5041enabled again later.
5042
5043@kindex enable display
5044@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5045Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5046again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5047
5048@item display
5049Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5050done when your program stops.
5051
5052@kindex info display
5053@item info display
5054Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5055automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5056values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5057It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5058because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5059@end table
5060
5061If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5062sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5063expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5064variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5065@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5066@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5067continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5068there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5069automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5070is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5071
6d2ebf8b 5072@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5073@section Print settings
5074
5075@cindex format options
5076@cindex print settings
5077@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5078and symbols are printed.
5079
5080@noindent
5081These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5082
5083@table @code
5084@kindex set print address
5085@item set print address
5086@itemx set print address on
5087@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5088traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5089even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5090is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5091@code{set print address on}:
5092
5093@smallexample
5094@group
5095(@value{GDBP}) f
5096#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5097 at input.c:530
5098530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5099@end group
5100@end smallexample
5101
5102@item set print address off
5103Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5104this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5105
5106@smallexample
5107@group
5108(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5109(@value{GDBP}) f
5110#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5111530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5112@end group
5113@end smallexample
5114
5115You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5116dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5117@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5118all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5119
5120@kindex show print address
5121@item show print address
5122Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5123@end table
5124
5125When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5126closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5127identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5128source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5129@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5130you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5131it prints a symbolic address:
5132
5133@table @code
5134@kindex set print symbol-filename
5135@item set print symbol-filename on
5136Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5137symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5138
5139@item set print symbol-filename off
5140Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5141default.
5142
5143@kindex show print symbol-filename
5144@item show print symbol-filename
5145Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5146line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5147@end table
5148
5149Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5150numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5151number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5152
5153Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5154printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5155
5156@table @code
5157@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5158@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5159Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5160offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5161@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5162to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5163
5164@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5165@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5166Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5167symbolic address.
5168@end table
5169
5170@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5171@cindex pointer, finding referent
5172If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5173@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5174and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5175@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5176For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5177at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5178
474c8240 5179@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5180(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5181(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5182$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5183@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5184
5185@quotation
5186@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5187does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5188the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5189@end quotation
5190
5191Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5192
5193@table @code
5194@kindex set print array
5195@item set print array
5196@itemx set print array on
5197Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5198but uses more space. The default is off.
5199
5200@item set print array off
5201Return to compressed format for arrays.
5202
5203@kindex show print array
5204@item show print array
5205Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5206arrays.
5207
5208@kindex set print elements
5209@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5210Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5211If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5212printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5213This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5214When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5215Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5216
5217@kindex show print elements
5218@item show print elements
5219Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5220If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5221
5222@kindex set print null-stop
5223@item set print null-stop
5224Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5225@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5226contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5227The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5228
5229@kindex set print pretty
5230@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5231Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5232per line, like this:
5233
5234@smallexample
5235@group
5236$1 = @{
5237 next = 0x0,
5238 flags = @{
5239 sweet = 1,
5240 sour = 1
5241 @},
5242 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5243@}
5244@end group
5245@end smallexample
5246
5247@item set print pretty off
5248Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5249
5250@smallexample
5251@group
5252$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5253meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5254@end group
5255@end smallexample
5256
5257@noindent
5258This is the default format.
5259
5260@kindex show print pretty
5261@item show print pretty
5262Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5263
5264@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5265@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5266Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5267@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5268character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5269best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5270high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5271
5272@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5273Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5274international character sets, and is the default.
5275
5276@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5277@item show print sevenbit-strings
5278Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5279
5280@kindex set print union
5281@item set print union on
5d161b24 5282Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5283is the default setting.
5284
5285@item set print union off
5286Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5287
5288@kindex show print union
5289@item show print union
5290Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5291structures.
5292
5293For example, given the declarations
5294
5295@smallexample
5296typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5297typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5298typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5299 Bug_forms;
5300
5301struct thing @{
5302 Species it;
5303 union @{
5304 Tree_forms tree;
5305 Bug_forms bug;
5306 @} form;
5307@};
5308
5309struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5310@end smallexample
5311
5312@noindent
5313with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5314
5315@smallexample
5316$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5317@end smallexample
5318
5319@noindent
5320and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5321
5322@smallexample
5323$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5324@end smallexample
5325@end table
5326
c906108c
SS
5327@need 1000
5328@noindent
b37052ae 5329These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5330
5331@table @code
5332@cindex demangling
5333@kindex set print demangle
5334@item set print demangle
5335@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5336Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5337(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5338linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5339
5340@kindex show print demangle
5341@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5342Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5343
5344@kindex set print asm-demangle
5345@item set print asm-demangle
5346@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5347Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5348in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5349The default is off.
5350
5351@kindex show print asm-demangle
5352@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5353Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5354or demangled form.
5355
5356@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5357@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5358@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5359@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5360Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5361represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5362
5363@table @code
5364@item auto
5365Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5366
5367@item gnu
b37052ae 5368Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5369This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5370
5371@item hp
b37052ae 5372Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5373
5374@item lucid
b37052ae 5375Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5376
5377@item arm
b37052ae 5378Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5379@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5380debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5381require further enhancement to permit that.
5382
5383@end table
5384If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5385
5386@kindex show demangle-style
5387@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5388Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5389
5390@kindex set print object
5391@item set print object
5392@itemx set print object on
5393When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5394(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5395the virtual function table.
5396
5397@item set print object off
5398Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5399virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5400
5401@kindex show print object
5402@item show print object
5403Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5404
5405@kindex set print static-members
5406@item set print static-members
5407@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5408Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5409
5410@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5411Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5412
5413@kindex show print static-members
5414@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5415Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5416
5417@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5418@kindex set print vtbl
5419@item set print vtbl
5420@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5421Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5422(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5423ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5424
5425@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5426Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5427
5428@kindex show print vtbl
5429@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5430Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5431@end table
c906108c 5432
6d2ebf8b 5433@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5434@section Value history
5435
5436@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5437Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5438@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5439Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5440(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5441When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5442since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5443symbol table.
5444
5445@cindex @code{$}
5446@cindex @code{$$}
5447@cindex history number
5448The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5449refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5450@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5451printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5452history number.
5453
5454To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5455history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5456remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5457the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5458@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5459is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5460@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5461
5462For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5463want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5464
474c8240 5465@smallexample
c906108c 5466p *$
474c8240 5467@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5468
5469If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5470to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5471
474c8240 5472@smallexample
c906108c 5473p *$.next
474c8240 5474@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5475
5476@noindent
5477You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5478command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5479
5480Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5481@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5482
474c8240 5483@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5484print x
5485set x=5
474c8240 5486@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5487
5488@noindent
5489then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5490remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5491
5492@table @code
5493@kindex show values
5494@item show values
5495Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5496This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5497values} does not change the history.
5498
5499@item show values @var{n}
5500Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5501
5502@item show values +
5503Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5504values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5505@end table
5506
5507Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5508same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5509
6d2ebf8b 5510@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5511@section Convenience variables
5512
5513@cindex convenience variables
5514@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5515@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5516exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5517setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5518of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5519
5520Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5521@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5522the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5523(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5524by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5525
5526You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5527expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5528For example:
5529
474c8240 5530@smallexample
c906108c 5531set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5532@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5533
5534@noindent
5535would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5536@code{object_ptr}.
5537
5538Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5539value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5540value with another assignment at any time.
5541
5542Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5543variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5544that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5545variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5546
5547@table @code
5548@kindex show convenience
5549@item show convenience
5550Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5551Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5552@end table
5553
5554One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5555incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5556a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5557
474c8240 5558@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5559set $i = 0
5560print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5561@end smallexample
c906108c 5562
d4f3574e
SS
5563@noindent
5564Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5565
5566Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5567values likely to be useful.
5568
5569@table @code
41afff9a 5570@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5571@item $_
5572The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5573the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5574commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5575set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5576and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5577except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5578to the type of @code{$__}.
5579
41afff9a 5580@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5581@item $__
5582The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5583to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5584to match the format in which the data was printed.
5585
5586@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5587@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5588The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5589the program being debugged terminates.
5590@end table
5591
53a5351d
JM
5592On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5593begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5594name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5595
6d2ebf8b 5596@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5597@section Registers
5598
5599@cindex registers
5600You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5601with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5602for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5603your machine.
5604
5605@table @code
5606@kindex info registers
5607@item info registers
5608Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
c85508ee 5609and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5610
5611@kindex info all-registers
5612@cindex floating point registers
5613@item info all-registers
5614Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
c85508ee 5615and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5616
5617@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5618Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5619As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5620the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5621the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5622@end table
5623
5624@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5625expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5626architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5627@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5628the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5629pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5630register that contains the processor status. For example,
5631you could print the program counter in hex with
5632
474c8240 5633@smallexample
c906108c 5634p/x $pc
474c8240 5635@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5636
5637@noindent
5638or print the instruction to be executed next with
5639
474c8240 5640@smallexample
c906108c 5641x/i $pc
474c8240 5642@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5643
5644@noindent
5645or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5646one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5647memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5648stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5649stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5650regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5651see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5652
474c8240 5653@smallexample
c906108c 5654set $sp += 4
474c8240 5655@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5656
5657Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5658your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5659so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5660shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5661registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5662can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5663is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5664
5665@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5666integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5667special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5668registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5669to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5670(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5671@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5672
5673Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5674means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5675the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5676sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5677coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5678programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5679cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5680that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5681prints the data in both formats.
5682
5683Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5684(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5685value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5686were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5687true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5688frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5689
5690However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5691code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5692@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5693frame makes no difference.
5694
6d2ebf8b 5695@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5696@section Floating point hardware
5697@cindex floating point
5698
5699Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5700you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5701
5702@table @code
5703@kindex info float
5704@item info float
5705Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5706point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5707floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5708the ARM and x86 machines.
5709@end table
c906108c 5710
e76f1f2e
AC
5711@node Vector Unit
5712@section Vector Unit
5713@cindex vector unit
5714
5715Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5716more information about the status of the vector unit.
5717
5718@table @code
5719@kindex info vector
5720@item info vector
5721Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5722layout vary depending on the hardware.
5723@end table
5724
29e57380 5725@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5726@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5727@cindex memory region attributes
5728
5729@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5730required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5731to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5732use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5733
5734Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5735memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5736accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5737been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5738all memory.
5739
5740When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5741to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5742
5743@table @code
5744@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5745@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5746Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5747attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5748special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5749(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5750
5751@kindex delete mem
5752@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5753Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5754
5755@kindex disable mem
5756@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5757Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5758A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5759It may be enabled again later.
5760
5761@kindex enable mem
5762@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5763Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5764
5765@kindex info mem
5766@item info mem
5767Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5768for each region.
5769
5770@table @emph
5771@item Memory Region Number
5772@item Enabled or Disabled.
5773Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5774Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5775
5776@item Lo Address
5777The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5778
5779@item Hi Address
5780The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5781
5782@item Attributes
5783The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5784@end table
5785@end table
5786
5787
5788@subsection Attributes
5789
5790@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5791The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5792write accesses to a memory region.
5793
5794While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5795memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5796etc. from accessing memory.
5797
5798@table @code
5799@item ro
5800Memory is read only.
5801@item wo
5802Memory is write only.
5803@item rw
6ca652b0 5804Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5805@end table
5806
5807@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5808The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5809accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5810require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5811specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5812
5813@table @code
5814@item 8
5815Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5816@item 16
5817Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5818@item 32
5819Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5820@item 64
5821Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5822@end table
5823
5824@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5825@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5826@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5827@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5828@c
5829@c @table @code
5830@c @item hwbreak
5831@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5832@c @item swbreak (default)
5833@c @end table
5834
5835@subsubsection Data Cache
5836The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5837memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5838protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5839does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5840registers.
5841
5842@table @code
5843@item cache
5844Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5845@item nocache
5846Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5847@end table
5848
5849@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5850@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5851@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5852@c
5853@c @table @code
5854@c @item verify
5855@c @item noverify (default)
5856@c @end table
5857
16d9dec6
MS
5858@node Dump/Restore Files
5859@section Copy between memory and a file
5860@cindex dump/restore files
5861@cindex append data to a file
5862@cindex dump data to a file
5863@cindex restore data from a file
5864@kindex dump
5865@kindex append
5866@kindex restore
5867
5868The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5869for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5870into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5871file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5872intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5873
5874@table @code
5875@kindex dump binary
5876@kindex append binary
5877@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5878Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5879raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5880
5881@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5882Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5883raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5884
5885@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5886Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5887
5888@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5889Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5890
5891@kindex dump ihex
5892@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5893Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5894intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5895
5896@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5897Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5898
5899@kindex dump srec
5900@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5901Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5902srec format file @var{filename}.
5903
5904@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5905Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5906
5907@kindex dump tekhex
5908@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5909Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5910tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5911
5912@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5913Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5914
42f9b0a5 5915@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5916Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5917command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5918raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5919@var{binary} after the filename.
5920
5921If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5922contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5923they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5924a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5925from that location.
5926
5927If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5928file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5929These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5930the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5931
5932@end table
5933
a0eb71c5
KB
5934@node Character Sets
5935@section Character Sets
5936@cindex character sets
5937@cindex charset
5938@cindex translating between character sets
5939@cindex host character set
5940@cindex target character set
5941
5942If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5943represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5944@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5945you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5946character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5947@dfn{target character set}.
5948
5949For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5950uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5951remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5952running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5953then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5954@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
e33d66ec 5955target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
a0eb71c5
KB
5956@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5957character and string literals in expressions.
5958
5959@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5960the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5961target-charset} command, described below.
5962
5963Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5964support:
5965
5966@table @code
5967@item set target-charset @var{charset}
5968@kindex set target-charset
5969Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
e33d66ec
EZ
5970character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
5971@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
5972list the target character sets it supports.
a0eb71c5
KB
5973@end table
5974
5975@table @code
5976@item set host-charset @var{charset}
5977@kindex set host-charset
5978Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5979
5980By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5981system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5982@code{set host-charset} command.
5983
5984@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5985set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
e33d66ec
EZ
5986indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
5987@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
5988list the host character sets it supports.
a0eb71c5
KB
5989
5990@item set charset @var{charset}
5991@kindex set charset
e33d66ec
EZ
5992Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
5993above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
5994@value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
5995for both host and target.
5996
a0eb71c5
KB
5997
5998@item show charset
a0eb71c5 5999@kindex show charset
e33d66ec
EZ
6000Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
6001
6002@itemx show host-charset
a0eb71c5 6003@kindex show host-charset
e33d66ec
EZ
6004Show the name of the current host charset.
6005
6006@itemx show target-charset
a0eb71c5 6007@kindex show target-charset
e33d66ec 6008Show the name of the current target charset.
a0eb71c5
KB
6009
6010@end table
6011
6012@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6013sets:
6014
6015@table @code
6016
6017@item ASCII
6018@cindex ASCII character set
6019Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6020character set.
6021
6022@item ISO-8859-1
6023@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6024@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
e33d66ec 6025The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
a0eb71c5
KB
6026characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6027this as its host character set.
6028
6029@item EBCDIC-US
6030@itemx IBM1047
6031@cindex EBCDIC character set
6032@cindex IBM1047 character set
6033Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6034mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6035@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6036
6037@end table
6038
6039Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6040GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6041encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6042
6043Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6044Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6045@file{charset-test.c}:
6046
6047@smallexample
6048#include <stdio.h>
6049
6050char ascii_hello[]
6051 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6052 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6053char ibm1047_hello[]
6054 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6055 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6056
6057main ()
6058@{
6059 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6060@}
10998722 6061@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6062
6063In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6064containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6065encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6066
6067We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6068
6069@smallexample
6070$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6071$ gdb -nw charset-test
6072GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6073Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6074@dots{}
6075(gdb)
10998722 6076@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6077
6078We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6079@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6080strings:
6081
6082@smallexample
6083(gdb) show charset
e33d66ec 6084The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
a0eb71c5 6085(gdb)
10998722 6086@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6087
6088For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6089initial character set:
6090@smallexample
e33d66ec 6091(gdb) set charset ASCII
a0eb71c5 6092(gdb) show charset
e33d66ec 6093The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
a0eb71c5 6094(gdb)
10998722 6095@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6096
6097Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6098host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6099characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6100them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6101@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6102
6103@smallexample
6104(gdb) print ascii_hello
6105$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6106(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6107$2 = 72 'H'
6108(gdb)
10998722 6109@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6110
6111@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6112literals you use in expressions:
6113
6114@smallexample
6115(gdb) print '+'
6116$3 = 43 '+'
6117(gdb)
10998722 6118@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6119
6120The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6121character.
6122
6123@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6124target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6125character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6126
6127@smallexample
6128(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6129$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6130(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6131$5 = 200 '\310'
6132(gdb)
10998722 6133@end smallexample
a0eb71c5 6134
e33d66ec 6135If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
a0eb71c5
KB
6136@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6137
6138@smallexample
6139(gdb) set target-charset
e33d66ec
EZ
6140ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
6141(gdb) set target-charset
10998722 6142@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6143
6144We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6145program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6146@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6147target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6148@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6149
6150@smallexample
e33d66ec 6151(gdb) set target-charset IBM1047
a0eb71c5 6152(gdb) show charset
e33d66ec
EZ
6153The current host character set is `ASCII'.
6154The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
a0eb71c5
KB
6155(gdb) print ascii_hello
6156$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6157(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6158$7 = 72 '\110'
6159(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6160$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6161(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6162$9 = 200 'H'
6163(gdb)
10998722 6164@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6165
6166As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6167string literals you use in expressions:
6168
6169@smallexample
6170(gdb) print '+'
6171$10 = 78 '+'
6172(gdb)
10998722 6173@end smallexample
a0eb71c5 6174
e33d66ec 6175The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
a0eb71c5
KB
6176character.
6177
6178
e2e0bcd1
JB
6179@node Macros
6180@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6181
6182Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6183``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6184@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6185the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6186where it was defined.
6187
6188You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6189with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6190include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6191with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6192
6193A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6194and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6195points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6196no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6197uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6198@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6199see @ref{List}.
6200
6201At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6202token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6203variable-arity macros.
6204
6205Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6206macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6207the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6208
6209@table @code
6210
6211@kindex macro expand
6212@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6213@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6214@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6215@item macro expand @var{expression}
6216@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6217Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6218@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6219not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6220it can be any string of tokens.
6221
6222@kindex macro expand-once
6223@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6224@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6225@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6226expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6227@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6228left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6229particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6230expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6231parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6232can be any string of tokens.
6233
475b0867 6234@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
6235@cindex macro definition, showing
6236@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 6237@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
6238Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6239source location where that definition was established.
6240
6241@kindex macro define
6242@cindex user-defined macros
6243@cindex defining macros interactively
6244@cindex macros, user-defined
6245@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6246@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6247@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6248preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6249by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6250command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6251second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6252given in @var{arglist}.
6253
6254A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6255evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6256undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6257definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6258well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6259
6260@kindex macro undef
6261@item macro undef @var{macro}
6262@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6263definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6264definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6265above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6266debugged.
6267
6268@end table
6269
6270@cindex macros, example of debugging with
6271Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6272show our source files:
6273
6274@smallexample
6275$ cat sample.c
6276#include <stdio.h>
6277#include "sample.h"
6278
6279#define M 42
6280#define ADD(x) (M + x)
6281
6282main ()
6283@{
6284#define N 28
6285 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6286#undef N
6287 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6288#define N 1729
6289 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6290@}
6291$ cat sample.h
6292#define Q <
6293$
6294@end smallexample
6295
6296Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6297We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6298compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6299information.
6300
6301@smallexample
6302$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6303$
6304@end smallexample
6305
6306Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6307
6308@smallexample
6309$ gdb -nw sample
6310GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6311Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6312GDB is free software, @dots{}
6313(gdb)
6314@end smallexample
6315
6316We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6317program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6318to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6319
6320@smallexample
6321(gdb) list main
63223
63234 #define M 42
63245 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
63256
63267 main ()
63278 @{
63289 #define N 28
632910 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
633011 #undef N
633112 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6332(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6333Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6334#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6335(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6336Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6337 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6338#define Q <
6339(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6340expands to: (42 + 1)
6341(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6342expands to: once (M + 1)
6343(gdb)
6344@end smallexample
6345
6346In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6347the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6348@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6349which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6350
6351Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6352the source line of the current stack frame:
6353
6354@smallexample
6355(gdb) break main
6356Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6357(gdb) run
6358Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6359
6360Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
636110 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6362(gdb)
6363@end smallexample
6364
6365At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6366
6367@smallexample
475b0867 6368(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6369Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6370#define N 28
6371(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6372expands to: 28 < 42
6373(gdb) print N Q M
6374$1 = 1
6375(gdb)
6376@end smallexample
6377
6378As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6379give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6380thereof) in force at each point:
6381
6382@smallexample
6383(gdb) next
6384Hello, world!
638512 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6386(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6387The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6388at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6389(gdb) next
6390We're so creative.
639114 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6392(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6393Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6394#define N 1729
6395(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6396expands to: 1729 < 42
6397(gdb) print N Q M
6398$2 = 0
6399(gdb)
6400@end smallexample
6401
6402
b37052ae
EZ
6403@node Tracepoints
6404@chapter Tracepoints
6405@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6406@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6407
6408@cindex tracepoints
6409In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6410the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6411anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6412depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6413might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6414fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6415to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6416
6417Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6418specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6419arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6420Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6421those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6422expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6423for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6424a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6425in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6426values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6427unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6428
6429The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6430targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6431to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6432stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6433tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6434
6435This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6436
6437@menu
6438* Set Tracepoints::
6439* Analyze Collected Data::
6440* Tracepoint Variables::
6441@end menu
6442
6443@node Set Tracepoints
6444@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6445
6446Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6447tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6448tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6449breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6450one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6451tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6452work on.
6453
6454For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6455of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6456it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6457local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6458commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6459tracepoint was hit.
6460
6461This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6462conditions and actions.
6463
6464@menu
6465* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6466* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6467* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6468* Tracepoint Actions::
6469* Listing Tracepoints::
6470* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6471@end menu
6472
6473@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6474@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6475
6476@table @code
6477@cindex set tracepoint
6478@kindex trace
6479@item trace
6480The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6481Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6482the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6483defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6484debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6485program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6486doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6487cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6488running.
6489
6490Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6491
6492@smallexample
6493(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6494
6495(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6496
6497(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6498
6499(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6500
6501(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6502@end smallexample
6503
6504@noindent
6505You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6506
6507@vindex $tpnum
6508@cindex last tracepoint number
6509@cindex recent tracepoint number
6510@cindex tracepoint number
6511The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6512of the most recently set tracepoint.
6513
6514@kindex delete tracepoint
6515@cindex tracepoint deletion
6516@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6517Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6518default is to delete all tracepoints.
6519
6520Examples:
6521
6522@smallexample
6523(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6524
6525(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6526@end smallexample
6527
6528@noindent
6529You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6530@end table
6531
6532@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6533@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6534
6535@table @code
6536@kindex disable tracepoint
6537@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6538Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6539@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6540the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6541a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6542
6543@kindex enable tracepoint
6544@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6545Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6546tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6547run.
6548@end table
6549
6550@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6551@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6552
6553@table @code
6554@kindex passcount
6555@cindex tracepoint pass count
6556@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6557Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6558automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6559@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6560the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6561@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6562passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6563given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6564user.
6565
6566Examples:
6567
6568@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6569(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6570@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6571
6572(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6573@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6574(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6575(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6576(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6577(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6578(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6579(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6580@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6581@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6582@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6583@end smallexample
6584@end table
6585
6586@node Tracepoint Actions
6587@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6588
6589@table @code
6590@kindex actions
6591@cindex tracepoint actions
6592@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6593This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6594tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6595specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6596recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6597@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6598actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6599terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6600far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6601@code{while-stepping}.
6602
6603@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6604To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6605and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6606
6607@smallexample
6608(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6609
6826cf00 6610(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6611
6826cf00 6612(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6613@end smallexample
6614
6615In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6616commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6617hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6618following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6619followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6620@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6621@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6622@code{end} command.
6623
6624@smallexample
6625(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6626(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6627Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6628> collect bar,baz
6629> collect $regs
6630> while-stepping 12
6631 > collect $fp, $sp
6632 > end
6633end
6634@end smallexample
6635
6636@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6637@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6638Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6639This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6640In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6641special arguments are supported:
6642
6643@table @code
6644@item $regs
6645collect all registers
6646
6647@item $args
6648collect all function arguments
6649
6650@item $locals
6651collect all local variables.
6652@end table
6653
6654You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6655with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6656arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6657
f5c37c66
EZ
6658The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6659particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6660
b37052ae
EZ
6661@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6662@item while-stepping @var{n}
6663Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6664new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6665followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6666its own @code{end} command):
6667
6668@smallexample
6669> while-stepping 12
6670 > collect $regs, myglobal
6671 > end
6672>
6673@end smallexample
6674
6675@noindent
6676You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6677@code{stepping}.
6678@end table
6679
6680@node Listing Tracepoints
6681@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6682
6683@table @code
6684@kindex info tracepoints
6685@cindex information about tracepoints
6686@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6687Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6688a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6689defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6690shown:
6691
6692@itemize @bullet
6693@item
6694its number
6695@item
6696whether it is enabled or disabled
6697@item
6698its address
6699@item
6700its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6701@item
6702its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6703@item
6704where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6705@item
6706its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6707@end itemize
6708
6709@smallexample
6710(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6711Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
67121 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
67132 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
67143 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6715(@value{GDBP})
6716@end smallexample
6717
6718@noindent
6719This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6720@end table
6721
6722@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6723@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6724
6725@table @code
6726@kindex tstart
6727@cindex start a new trace experiment
6728@cindex collected data discarded
6729@item tstart
6730This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6731begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6732the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6733experiment.
6734
6735@kindex tstop
6736@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6737@item tstop
6738This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6739stops collecting data.
6740
6741@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6742automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6743(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6744
6745@kindex tstatus
6746@cindex status of trace data collection
6747@cindex trace experiment, status of
6748@item tstatus
6749This command displays the status of the current trace data
6750collection.
6751@end table
6752
6753Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6754
6755@smallexample
6756(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6757(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6758Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6759> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6760> while-stepping 11
6761 > collect $regs
6762 > end
6763> end
6764(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6765 [time passes @dots{}]
6766(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6767@end smallexample
6768
6769
6770@node Analyze Collected Data
6771@section Using the collected data
6772
6773After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6774for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6775collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6776snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6777consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6778examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6779specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6780snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6781registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6782rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6783debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6784(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6785behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6786when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6787the buffer will fail.
6788
6789@menu
6790* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6791* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6792* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6793@end menu
6794
6795@node tfind
6796@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6797
6798@kindex tfind
6799@cindex select trace snapshot
6800@cindex find trace snapshot
6801The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6802@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6803counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6804snapshot is selected.
6805
6806Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6807
6808@table @code
6809@item tfind start
6810Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6811@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6812
6813@item tfind none
6814Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6815
6816@item tfind end
6817Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6818
6819@item tfind
6820No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6821
6822@item tfind -
6823Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6824retracing earlier steps.
6825
6826@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6827Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6828proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6829argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6830for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6831
6832@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6833Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6834program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6835snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6836snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6837
6838@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6839Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6840addresses.
6841
6842@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6843Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6844@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6845
6846@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6847Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6848the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6849that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6850trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6851next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6852@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6853stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6854@end table
6855
6856The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6857designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6858instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6859snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6860trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6861simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6862snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6863@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6864The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6865for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6866no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6867(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6868no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6869tracepoint as the current one.
6870
6871In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6872these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6873scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6874you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6875registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6876
6877@smallexample
6878(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6879(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6880> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6881 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6882> tfind
6883> end
6884
6885Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6886Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6887Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6888Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6889Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6890Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6891Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6892Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6893Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6894Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6895Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6896@end smallexample
6897
6898Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6899the buffer:
6900
6901@smallexample
6902(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6903(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6904> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6905> tfind line
6906> end
6907
6908Frame 0, X = 1
6909Frame 7, X = 2
6910Frame 13, X = 255
6911@end smallexample
6912
6913@node tdump
6914@subsection @code{tdump}
6915@kindex tdump
6916@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6917@cindex tracepoint data, display
6918
6919This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6920the current trace snapshot.
6921
6922@smallexample
6923(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6924(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6925Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6926> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6927> end
6928
6929(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6930
6931(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6932#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6933at gdb_test.c:444
6934444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6935
6936(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6937Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6938d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6939d1 0x18 24
6940d2 0x80 128
6941d3 0x33 51
6942d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6943d5 0x22 34
6944d6 0xe0 224
6945d7 0x380035 3670069
6946a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6947a1 0x3000668 50333288
6948a2 0x100 256
6949a3 0x322000 3284992
6950a4 0x3000698 50333336
6951a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6952fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6953sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6954ps 0x0 0
6955pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6956fpcontrol 0x0 0
6957fpstatus 0x0 0
6958fpiaddr 0x0 0
6959p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6960p1 = (void *) 0x11
6961p2 = (void *) 0x22
6962p3 = (void *) 0x33
6963p4 = (void *) 0x44
6964p5 = (void *) 0x55
6965p6 = (void *) 0x66
6966gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6967
6968(@value{GDBP})
6969@end smallexample
6970
6971@node save-tracepoints
6972@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6973@kindex save-tracepoints
6974@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6975
6976This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6977their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6978suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6979tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6980Files}).
6981
6982@node Tracepoint Variables
6983@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6984@cindex tracepoint variables
6985@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6986
6987@table @code
6988@vindex $trace_frame
6989@item (int) $trace_frame
6990The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6991snapshot is selected.
6992
6993@vindex $tracepoint
6994@item (int) $tracepoint
6995The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6996
6997@vindex $trace_line
6998@item (int) $trace_line
6999The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7000
7001@vindex $trace_file
7002@item (char []) $trace_file
7003The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7004
7005@vindex $trace_func
7006@item (char []) $trace_func
7007The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7008@end table
7009
7010Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7011use @code{output} instead.
7012
7013Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7014stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7015data.
7016
7017@smallexample
7018(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7019
7020(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7021> output $trace_file
7022> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7023> tfind
7024> end
7025@end smallexample
7026
df0cd8c5
JB
7027@node Overlays
7028@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7029@cindex overlays
7030
7031If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7032memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7033problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7034use overlays.
7035
7036@menu
7037* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7038* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7039* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7040 mapped by asking the inferior.
7041* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7042@end menu
7043
7044@node How Overlays Work
7045@section How Overlays Work
7046@cindex mapped overlays
7047@cindex unmapped overlays
7048@cindex load address, overlay's
7049@cindex mapped address
7050@cindex overlay area
7051
7052Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7053kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7054other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7055management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7056adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7057
7058One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7059independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7060@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7061their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7062instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7063largest overlay as well.
7064
7065Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7066overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7067for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7068there.
7069
c928edc0
AC
7070@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7071@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7072@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7073
474c8240 7074@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7075@group
c928edc0
AC
7076 Data Instruction Larger
7077Address Space Address Space Address Space
7078+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7079| | | | | |
7080+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7081| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7082| variables | | program | | +-----------+
7083| and heap | | | | | |
7084+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7085| | +-----------+ | | | load address
7086+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7087 | | | | | |
7088 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7089 address | | | | | |
7090 | overlay | <-' | | |
7091 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7092 | | <---. | | load address
7093 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7094 | | | |
7095 +-----------+ | |
7096 +-----------+
7097 | |
7098 +-----------+
7099
7100 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 7101@end group
474c8240 7102@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 7103
c928edc0
AC
7104The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7105and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7106its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7107Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7108may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7109data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7110program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7111program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
7112
7113An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7114@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7115instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7116in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7117is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7118the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7119called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7120
7121Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7122program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7123global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7124
7125@itemize @bullet
7126
7127@item
7128Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7129must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7130return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7131overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7132
7133@item
7134If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7135will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7136your program's performance.
7137
7138@item
7139The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7140overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7141mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7142and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7143You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7144addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7145ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7146
7147@item
7148The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7149to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7150instruction and data spaces.
7151
7152@end itemize
7153
7154The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7155improved in many ways:
7156
7157@itemize @bullet
7158
7159@item
7160If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7161hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7162contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7163This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7164area in the usual way.
7165
7166@item
7167If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7168overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7169
7170@item
7171You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7172general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7173code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7174return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7175the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7176must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7177different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7178
7179@end itemize
7180
7181
7182@node Overlay Commands
7183@section Overlay Commands
7184
7185To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7186correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7187virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7188mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7189@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7190variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7191
7192@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7193you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7194
7195@table @code
7196@item overlay off
7197@kindex overlay off
7198Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7199disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7200always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7201overlay support is disabled.
7202
7203@item overlay manual
7204@kindex overlay manual
7205@cindex manual overlay debugging
7206Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7207relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7208using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7209commands described below.
7210
7211@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7212@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7213@kindex overlay map-overlay
7214@cindex map an overlay
7215Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7216be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7217overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7218functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7219that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7220@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7221
7222@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7223@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7224@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7225@cindex unmap an overlay
7226Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7227must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7228When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7229overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7230
7231@item overlay auto
7232@kindex overlay auto
7233Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7234consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7235to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7236Overlay Debugging}.
7237
7238@item overlay load-target
7239@itemx overlay load
7240@kindex overlay load-target
7241@cindex reloading the overlay table
7242Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7243re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7244stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7245overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7246useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7247
7248@item overlay list-overlays
7249@itemx overlay list
7250@cindex listing mapped overlays
7251Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7252addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7253
7254@end table
7255
7256Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7257of the function the address falls in:
7258
474c8240 7259@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7260(gdb) print main
7261$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 7262@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7263@noindent
7264When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7265unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7266asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7267unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7268
474c8240 7269@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7270(gdb) overlay list
7271No sections are mapped.
7272(gdb) print foo
7273$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 7274@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7275@noindent
7276When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7277name normally:
7278
474c8240 7279@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7280(gdb) overlay list
7281Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7282 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7283(gdb) print foo
7284$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 7285@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7286
7287When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7288address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7289overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7290@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7291code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7292
7293@itemize @bullet
7294@item
7295@cindex breakpoints in overlays
7296@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7297You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7298@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7299@item
7300@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7301unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7302overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7303you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7304breakpoints properly.
7305@end itemize
7306
7307
7308@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7309@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7310@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7311
7312@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7313are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7314inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7315@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7316looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7317current state of the overlays.
7318
7319Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7320@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7321
7322@table @asis
7323
7324@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7325This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7326
474c8240 7327@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7328struct
7329@{
7330 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7331 unsigned long vma;
7332
7333 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7334 unsigned long size;
7335
7336 /* The overlay's load address. */
7337 unsigned long lma;
7338
7339 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7340 zero otherwise. */
7341 unsigned long mapped;
7342@}
474c8240 7343@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7344
7345@item @code{_novlys}:
7346This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7347number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7348
7349@end table
7350
7351To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7352looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7353@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7354executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7355the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7356currently mapped.
7357
81d46470 7358In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7359@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7360will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7361calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7362will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7363are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7364in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7365overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7366are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7367
7368@node Overlay Sample Program
7369@section Overlay Sample Program
7370@cindex overlay example program
7371
7372When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7373at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7374addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7375Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7376since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7377architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7378portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7379
7380However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7381program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7382suite. The program consists of the following files from
7383@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7384
7385@table @file
7386@item overlays.c
7387The main program file.
7388@item ovlymgr.c
7389A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7390@item foo.c
7391@itemx bar.c
7392@itemx baz.c
7393@itemx grbx.c
7394Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7395@item d10v.ld
7396@itemx m32r.ld
7397Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7398and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7399@end table
7400
7401You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7402cross-compiler like this:
7403
474c8240 7404@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7405$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7406$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7407$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7408$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7409$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7410$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7411$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7412 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7413@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7414
7415The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7416you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7417target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7418
7419
6d2ebf8b 7420@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7421@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7422@cindex languages
7423
c906108c
SS
7424Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7425rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7426dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7427Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7428represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7429@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7430
7431@cindex working language
7432Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7433allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7434native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7435consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7436language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7437language}.
7438
7439@menu
7440* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7441* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7442* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7443* Support:: Supported languages
7444@end menu
7445
6d2ebf8b 7446@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7447@section Switching between source languages
7448
7449There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7450set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7451@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7452defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7453used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7454are printed, etc.
7455
7456In addition to the working language, every source file that
7457@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7458file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7459source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7460language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7461controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7462show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7463set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7464set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7465Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7466
7467This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7468as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7469another language. In that case, make the
7470program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7471@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7472program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7473
7474@menu
7475* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7476* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7477* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7478@end menu
7479
6d2ebf8b 7480@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7481@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7482
7483If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7484@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7485
7486@table @file
7487
7488@item .c
7489C source file
7490
7491@item .C
7492@itemx .cc
7493@itemx .cp
7494@itemx .cpp
7495@itemx .cxx
7496@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7497C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7498
7499@item .f
7500@itemx .F
7501Fortran source file
7502
c906108c
SS
7503@item .mod
7504Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7505
7506@item .s
7507@itemx .S
7508Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7509@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7510@end table
7511
7512In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7513extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7514
6d2ebf8b 7515@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7516@subsection Setting the working language
7517
7518If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7519expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7520your program.
7521
7522@kindex set language
7523If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7524command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7525a language, such as
c906108c 7526@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7527For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7528
c906108c
SS
7529Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7530language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7531to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7532source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7533languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7534source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7535command such as:
7536
474c8240 7537@smallexample
c906108c 7538print a = b + c
474c8240 7539@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7540
7541@noindent
7542might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7543@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7544printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7545@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7546
6d2ebf8b 7547@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7548@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7549
7550To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7551@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7552then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7553frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7554working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7555frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7556or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7557does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7558not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7559
7560This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7561entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7562written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7563a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7564case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7565
6d2ebf8b 7566@node Show
c906108c 7567@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7568
7569The following commands help you find out which language is the
7570working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7571
7572@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7573@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7574@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7575@table @code
7576@item show language
7577Display the current working language. This is the
7578language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7579build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7580
7581@item info frame
5d161b24 7582Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7583working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7584@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7585information listed here.
7586
7587@item info source
7588Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7589@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7590information listed here.
7591@end table
7592
7593In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7594not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7595with a language explicitly:
7596
7597@kindex set extension-language
7598@kindex info extensions
7599@table @code
7600@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7601Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7602the source language @var{language}.
7603
7604@item info extensions
7605List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7606@end table
7607
6d2ebf8b 7608@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7609@section Type and range checking
7610
7611@quotation
7612@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7613checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7614section documents the intended facilities.
7615@end quotation
7616@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7617
7618Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7619errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7620checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7621sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7622these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7623by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7624errors when your program is running.
7625
7626@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7627Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7628can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7629the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7630@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7631your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7632for the default settings of supported languages.
7633
7634@menu
7635* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7636* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7637@end menu
7638
7639@cindex type checking
7640@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7641@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7642@subsection An overview of type checking
7643
7644Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7645arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7646otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7647errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7648
7649@smallexample
76501 + 2 @result{} 3
7651@exdent but
7652@error{} 1 + 2.3
7653@end smallexample
7654
7655The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7656type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7657
5d161b24
DB
7658For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7659@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7660to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7661or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7662but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7663these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7664also issues a warning.
7665
5d161b24
DB
7666Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7667related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7668For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7669a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7670with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7671the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7672
7673Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7674instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7675operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7676represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7677operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7678details on specific languages.
7679
7680@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7681
d4f3574e 7682@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7683@kindex set check type
7684@kindex show check type
7685@table @code
7686@item set check type auto
7687Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7688@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7689each language.
7690
7691@item set check type on
7692@itemx set check type off
7693Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7694current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7695match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7696evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7697message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7698
7699@item set check type warn
7700Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7701evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7702be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7703numbers and structures.
7704
7705@item show type
5d161b24 7706Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7707is setting it automatically.
7708@end table
7709
7710@cindex range checking
7711@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7712@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7713@subsection An overview of range checking
7714
7715In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7716bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7717checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7718computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7719not exceed the bounds of the array.
7720
7721For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7722@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7723always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7724warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7725
7726A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7727array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7728of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7729error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7730result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7731the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7732
474c8240 7733@smallexample
c906108c 7734@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7735@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7736
7737This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7738specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7739Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7740
7741@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7742
d4f3574e 7743@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7744@kindex set check range
7745@kindex show check range
7746@table @code
7747@item set check range auto
7748Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7749@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7750each language.
7751
7752@item set check range on
7753@itemx set check range off
7754Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7755current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7756match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7757then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7758
7759@item set check range warn
7760Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7761but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7762expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7763memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7764systems).
7765
7766@item show range
7767Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7768being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7769@end table
c906108c 7770
6d2ebf8b 7771@node Support
c906108c 7772@section Supported languages
c906108c 7773
e632838e 7774@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7775@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7776Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7777language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7778and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7779,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7780language.
7781
7782The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7783supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7784tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7785@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7786formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7787books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7788language reference or tutorial.
7789
c906108c 7790@menu
b37052ae 7791* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7792* Modula-2:: Modula-2
c906108c
SS
7793@end menu
7794
6d2ebf8b 7795@node C
b37052ae 7796@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7797
b37052ae
EZ
7798@cindex C and C@t{++}
7799@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7800
b37052ae 7801Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7802to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7803together.
7804
41afff9a
EZ
7805@cindex C@t{++}
7806@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7807@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7808The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7809compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7810effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7811C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7812compiler (@code{aCC}).
7813
0179ffac
DC
7814For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
7815format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
7816format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
7817command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
7818@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7819CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
c906108c 7820
c906108c 7821@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7822* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7823* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7824* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7825* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7826* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7827* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7828* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7829@end menu
c906108c 7830
6d2ebf8b 7831@node C Operators
b37052ae 7832@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7833
b37052ae 7834@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7835
7836Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7837@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7838often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7839
b37052ae 7840For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7841
7842@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7843
c906108c 7844@item
c906108c 7845@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7846specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7847
7848@item
d4f3574e
SS
7849@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7850@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7851
7852@item
53a5351d 7853@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7854
7855@item
7856@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7857
c906108c
SS
7858@end itemize
7859
7860@noindent
7861The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7862in order of increasing precedence:
7863
7864@table @code
7865@item ,
7866The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7867are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7868expression being the last expression evaluated.
7869
7870@item =
7871Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7872assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7873
7874@item @var{op}=
7875Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7876and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7877@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7878@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7879@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7880
7881@item ?:
7882The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7883of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7884integral type.
7885
7886@item ||
7887Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7888
7889@item &&
7890Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7891
7892@item |
7893Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7894
7895@item ^
7896Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7897
7898@item &
7899Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7900
7901@item ==@r{, }!=
7902Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7903expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7904
7905@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7906Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7907Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7908and non-zero for true.
7909
7910@item <<@r{, }>>
7911left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7912
7913@item @@
7914The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7915
7916@item +@r{, }-
7917Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7918pointer types.
7919
7920@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7921Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7922defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7923integral types.
7924
7925@item ++@r{, }--
7926Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7927operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7928when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7929operation takes place.
7930
7931@item *
7932Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7933@code{++}.
7934
7935@item &
7936Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7937
b37052ae
EZ
7938For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7939allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7940(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7941where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7942stored.
c906108c
SS
7943
7944@item -
7945Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7946precedence as @code{++}.
7947
7948@item !
7949Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7950@code{++}.
7951
7952@item ~
7953Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7954@code{++}.
7955
7956
7957@item .@r{, }->
7958Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7959@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7960pointer based on the stored type information.
7961Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7962
c906108c
SS
7963@item .*@r{, }->*
7964Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7965
7966@item []
7967Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7968@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7969
7970@item ()
7971Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7972
c906108c 7973@item ::
b37052ae 7974C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7975and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7976
7977@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7978Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7979(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7980above.
c906108c
SS
7981@end table
7982
c906108c
SS
7983If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7984attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7985predefined meaning.
c906108c 7986
c906108c 7987@menu
5d161b24 7988* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7989@end menu
7990
6d2ebf8b 7991@node C Constants
b37052ae 7992@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7993
b37052ae 7994@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7995
b37052ae 7996@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7997following ways:
c906108c
SS
7998
7999@itemize @bullet
8000@item
8001Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
8002specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8003by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
8004@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8005@code{long} value.
8006
8007@item
8008Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8009point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8010exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8011@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8012sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
8013A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8014@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8015the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8016a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8017constant.
c906108c
SS
8018
8019@item
8020Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8021integral equivalents.
8022
8023@item
8024Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8025(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 8026(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
8027be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8028the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8029of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8030@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8031@samp{\n} for newline.
8032
8033@item
96a2c332
SS
8034String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8035double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8036above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8037a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8038characters.
c906108c
SS
8039
8040@item
8041Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8042to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8043
8044@item
8045Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8046and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8047integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8048and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8049@end itemize
8050
c906108c 8051@menu
5d161b24
DB
8052* C plus plus expressions::
8053* C Defaults::
8054* C Checks::
c906108c 8055
5d161b24 8056* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
8057@end menu
8058
6d2ebf8b 8059@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
8060@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8061
8062@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8063@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8064
0179ffac
DC
8065@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8066@cindex C@t{++} compilers
8067@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8068@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
c906108c 8069@quotation
b37052ae 8070@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
0179ffac
DC
8071proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8072works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8073@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8074@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8075stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8076stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8077specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8078are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8079C@t{++} code.
c906108c 8080@end quotation
c906108c
SS
8081
8082@enumerate
8083
8084@cindex member functions
8085@item
8086Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8087
474c8240 8088@smallexample
c906108c 8089count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 8090@end smallexample
c906108c 8091
41afff9a 8092@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 8093@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8094@item
8095While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8096expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8097that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 8098pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 8099
c906108c 8100@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 8101@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 8102@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8103@item
8104You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 8105call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
8106perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8107calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8108in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8109default arguments.
8110
8111It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8112promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8113class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8114functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8115number of function arguments.
8116
8117Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8118@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 8119,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 8120
d4f3574e 8121You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
8122explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8123@smallexample
8124p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8125@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8126
c906108c 8127The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 8128see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 8129
c906108c
SS
8130@cindex reference declarations
8131@item
b37052ae
EZ
8132@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8133them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
8134dereferenced.
8135
8136In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8137reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8138avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8139The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8140you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8141
8142@item
b37052ae 8143@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
8144expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8145one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8146necessary, for example in an expression like
8147@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 8148resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8149debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8150@end enumerate
8151
b37052ae 8152In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
8153calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8154objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8155invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 8156
6d2ebf8b 8157@node C Defaults
b37052ae 8158@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 8159
b37052ae 8160@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 8161
c906108c
SS
8162If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8163both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 8164C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8165selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
8166
8167If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8168recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8169@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 8170these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
8171@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8172for further details.
8173
c906108c
SS
8174@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8175@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8176@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 8177
6d2ebf8b 8178@node C Checks
b37052ae 8179@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 8180
b37052ae 8181@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 8182
b37052ae 8183By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
8184is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8185considers two variables type equivalent if:
8186
8187@itemize @bullet
8188@item
8189The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8190enumerated tag.
8191
8192@item
8193The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8194declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8195
8196@ignore
8197@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8198@c FIXME--beers?
8199@item
8200The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8201declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8202compilers.)
8203@end ignore
8204@end itemize
8205
8206Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8207indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8208that is not itself an array.
c906108c 8209
6d2ebf8b 8210@node Debugging C
c906108c 8211@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
8212
8213The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8214the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
8215inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8216appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
8217
8218The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8219with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8220,Expressions}.
8221
c906108c 8222@menu
5d161b24 8223* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
8224@end menu
8225
6d2ebf8b 8226@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 8227@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8228
b37052ae 8229@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8230
b37052ae
EZ
8231Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8232designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
8233
8234@table @code
8235@cindex break in overloaded functions
8236@item @r{breakpoint menus}
8237When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8238@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8239you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8240
b37052ae 8241@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8242@item rbreak @var{regex}
8243Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8244breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8245classes.
8246@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8247
b37052ae 8248@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
8249@item catch throw
8250@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 8251Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
8252Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8253
8254@cindex inheritance
8255@item ptype @var{typename}
8256Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8257@var{typename}.
8258@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8259
b37052ae 8260@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
8261@item set print demangle
8262@itemx show print demangle
8263@itemx set print asm-demangle
8264@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
8265Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8266displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
8267@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8268
8269@item set print object
8270@itemx show print object
8271Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8272@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8273
8274@item set print vtbl
8275@itemx show print vtbl
8276Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8277@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 8278(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 8279ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
8280
8281@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 8282@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8283@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8284Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8285is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8286and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8287using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8288expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8289message.
8290
8291@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8292Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8293overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8294chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8295symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8296overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8297searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8298argument types.
c906108c
SS
8299
8300@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8301You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8302the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8303@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8304also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8305available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8306@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8307@end table
c906108c 8308
6d2ebf8b 8309@node Modula-2
c906108c 8310@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8311
d4f3574e 8312@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8313
8314The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8315output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8316developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8317attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8318to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8319table.
8320
8321@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8322@menu
8323* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8324* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8325* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8326* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8327* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8328* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8329* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8330* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8331@end menu
8332
6d2ebf8b 8333@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8334@subsubsection Operators
8335@cindex Modula-2 operators
8336
8337Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8338@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8339often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8340following definitions hold:
8341
8342@itemize @bullet
8343
8344@item
8345@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8346their subranges.
8347
8348@item
8349@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8350
8351@item
8352@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8353
8354@item
8355@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8356@var{type}}.
8357
8358@item
8359@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8360
8361@item
8362@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8363
8364@item
8365@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8366@end itemize
8367
8368@noindent
8369The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8370increasing precedence:
8371
8372@table @code
8373@item ,
8374Function argument or array index separator.
8375
8376@item :=
8377Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8378@var{value}.
8379
8380@item <@r{, }>
8381Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8382types.
8383
8384@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8385Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8386on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8387set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8388
8389@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8390Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8391Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8392available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8393comment character.
8394
8395@item IN
8396Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8397Same precedence as @code{<}.
8398
8399@item OR
8400Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8401
8402@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8403Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8404
8405@item @@
8406The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8407
8408@item +@r{, }-
8409Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8410and difference on set types.
8411
8412@item *
8413Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8414on set types.
8415
8416@item /
8417Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8418types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8419
8420@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8421Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8422precedence as @code{*}.
8423
8424@item -
8425Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8426
8427@item ^
8428Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8429
8430@item NOT
8431Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8432@code{^}.
8433
8434@item .
8435@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8436precedence as @code{^}.
8437
8438@item []
8439Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8440
8441@item ()
8442Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8443as @code{^}.
8444
8445@item ::@r{, }.
8446@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8447@end table
8448
8449@quotation
8450@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8451treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8452@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8453@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8454@end quotation
8455
cb51c4e0 8456
6d2ebf8b 8457@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8458@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8459@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8460
8461Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8462In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8463
8464@table @var
8465
8466@item a
8467represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8468
8469@item c
8470represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8471
8472@item i
8473represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8474
8475@item m
8476represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8477same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8478be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8479
8480@item n
8481represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8482
8483@item r
8484represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8485
8486@item t
8487represents a type.
8488
8489@item v
8490represents a variable.
8491
8492@item x
8493represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8494explanation of the function for details.
8495@end table
8496
8497All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8498
8499@table @code
8500@item ABS(@var{n})
8501Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8502
8503@item CAP(@var{c})
8504If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8505equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8506
8507@item CHR(@var{i})
8508Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8509
8510@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8511Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8512
8513@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8514Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8515new value.
8516
8517@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8518Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8519set.
8520
8521@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8522Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8523
8524@item HIGH(@var{a})
8525Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8526
8527@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8528Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8529
8530@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8531Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8532new value.
8533
8534@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8535Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8536there. Returns the new set.
8537
8538@item MAX(@var{t})
8539Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8540
8541@item MIN(@var{t})
8542Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8543
8544@item ODD(@var{i})
8545Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8546
8547@item ORD(@var{x})
8548Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8549value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8550@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8551integral, character and enumerated types.
8552
8553@item SIZE(@var{x})
8554Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8555
8556@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8557Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8558
8559@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8560Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8561@end table
8562
8563@quotation
8564@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8565@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8566an error.
8567@end quotation
8568
8569@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8570@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8571@subsubsection Constants
8572
8573@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8574ways:
8575
8576@itemize @bullet
8577
8578@item
8579Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8580expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8581rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8582trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8583
8584@item
8585Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8586decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8587then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8588@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8589digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8590digits.
8591
8592@item
8593Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8594like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8595also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8596followed by a @samp{C}.
8597
8598@item
8599String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8600pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8601Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8602Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8603sequences.
8604
8605@item
8606Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8607
8608@item
8609Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8610@code{FALSE}.
8611
8612@item
8613Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8614
8615@item
8616Set constants are not yet supported.
8617@end itemize
8618
6d2ebf8b 8619@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8620@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8621@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8622
8623If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8624both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8625Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8626selected the working language.
8627
8628If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8629code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8630working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8631the language automatically}, for further details.
8632
6d2ebf8b 8633@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8634@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8635@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8636
8637A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8638This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8639
8640@itemize @bullet
8641@item
8642Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8643integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8644debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8645pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8646through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8647returned a pointer.)
8648
8649@item
8650C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8651non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8652escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8653printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8654
8655@item
8656The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8657argument.
8658
8659@item
8660All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8661@end itemize
8662
6d2ebf8b 8663@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8664@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8665@cindex Modula-2 checks
8666
8667@quotation
8668@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8669range checking.
8670@end quotation
8671@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8672
8673@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8674
8675@itemize @bullet
8676@item
8677They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8678@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8679
8680@item
8681They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8682@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8683@end itemize
8684
8685As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8686whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8687
8688Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8689index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8690
6d2ebf8b 8691@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8692@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8693@cindex scope
41afff9a 8694@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8695@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8696@ifinfo
41afff9a 8697@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8698@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8699@end ifinfo
8700@iftex
41afff9a 8701@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8702@end iftex
8703
8704There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8705(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8706similar syntax:
8707
474c8240 8708@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8709
8710@var{module} . @var{id}
8711@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8712@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8713
8714@noindent
8715where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8716@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8717identifier within your program, except another module.
8718
8719Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8720specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8721found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8722enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8723
8724Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8725the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8726definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8727an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8728module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8729@var{module}.
8730
6d2ebf8b 8731@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8732@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8733
8734Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8735Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8736specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8737@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8738apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8739analogue in Modula-2.
8740
8741The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8742with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8743intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8744created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8745address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8746@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8747
8748@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8749In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8750interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8751
6d2ebf8b 8752@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8753@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8754
d4f3574e 8755The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8756symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8757program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8758does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8759program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8760(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8761file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8762
8763@cindex symbol names
8764@cindex names of symbols
8765@cindex quoting names
8766Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8767characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8768most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8769source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8770are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8771ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8772@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8773@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8774
474c8240 8775@smallexample
c906108c 8776p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8777@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8778
8779@noindent
8780looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8781
8782@table @code
8783@kindex info address
b37052ae 8784@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8785@item info address @var{symbol}
8786Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8787variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8788local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8789is always stored.
8790
8791Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8792at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8793the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8794
3d67e040 8795@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8796@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8797@item info symbol @var{addr}
8798Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8799If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8800nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8801
474c8240 8802@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8803(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8804_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 8805@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8806
8807@noindent
8808This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8809it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8810
c906108c 8811@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8812@item whatis @var{expr}
8813Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8814actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8815assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8816@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8817
8818@item whatis
8819Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8820
8821@kindex ptype
8822@item ptype @var{typename}
8823Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8824the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8825@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8826@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8827
d4f3574e 8828@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8829@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8830Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8831differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8832of just the name of the type.
8833
8834For example, for this variable declaration:
8835
474c8240 8836@smallexample
c906108c 8837struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 8838@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8839
8840@noindent
8841the two commands give this output:
8842
474c8240 8843@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8844@group
8845(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8846type = struct complex
8847(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8848type = struct complex @{
8849 double real;
8850 double imag;
8851@}
8852@end group
474c8240 8853@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8854
8855@noindent
8856As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8857the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8858
8859@kindex info types
8860@item info types @var{regexp}
8861@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8862Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8863(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8864complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8865@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8866names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8867information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8868
8869This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8870@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8871lists all source files where a type is defined.
8872
b37052ae
EZ
8873@kindex info scope
8874@cindex local variables
8875@item info scope @var{addr}
8876List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8877accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8878preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8879scope defined by that location. For example:
8880
8881@smallexample
8882(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8883Scope for command_line_handler:
8884Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8885Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8886Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8887Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8888Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8889Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8890Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8891@end smallexample
8892
f5c37c66
EZ
8893@noindent
8894This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8895during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8896collect}.
8897
c906108c
SS
8898@kindex info source
8899@item info source
919d772c
JB
8900Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
8901the function containing the current point of execution:
8902@itemize @bullet
8903@item
8904the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
8905@item
8906the directory it was compiled in,
8907@item
8908its length, in lines,
8909@item
8910which programming language it is written in,
8911@item
8912whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
8913if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
8914@item
8915whether the debugging information includes information about
8916preprocessor macros.
8917@end itemize
8918
c906108c
SS
8919
8920@kindex info sources
8921@item info sources
8922Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8923debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8924have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8925
8926@kindex info functions
8927@item info functions
8928Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8929
8930@item info functions @var{regexp}
8931Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8932whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8933Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8934include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8935start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8936that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8937@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8938
8939@kindex info variables
8940@item info variables
8941Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 8942outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
8943
8944@item info variables @var{regexp}
8945Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8946variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8947@var{regexp}.
8948
8949@ignore
8950This was never implemented.
8951@kindex info methods
8952@item info methods
8953@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8954The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8955methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8956specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8957C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8958from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8959@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8960which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8961@end ignore
8962
c906108c
SS
8963@cindex reloading symbols
8964Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8965be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8966in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8967running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8968@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8969
8970@table @code
8971@kindex set symbol-reloading
8972@item set symbol-reloading on
8973Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8974object file with a particular name is seen again.
8975
8976@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8977Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8978same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8979running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8980should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8981may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8982several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8983name.
c906108c
SS
8984
8985@kindex show symbol-reloading
8986@item show symbol-reloading
8987Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8988@end table
c906108c 8989
c906108c
SS
8990@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8991@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8992Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8993declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8994@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8995source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8996another source file. The default is on.
8997
8998A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8999the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9000
9001@item set opaque-type-resolution off
9002Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9003is printed as follows:
9004@smallexample
9005@{<no data fields>@}
9006@end smallexample
9007
9008@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9009@item show opaque-type-resolution
9010Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
9011
9012@kindex maint print symbols
9013@cindex symbol dump
9014@kindex maint print psymbols
9015@cindex partial symbol dump
9016@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9017@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9018@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9019Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9020These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9021symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9022symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9023collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9024only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9025command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9026use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9027symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9028files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9029@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9030required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9031@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9032@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
44ea7b70
JB
9033
9034@kindex maint list symtabs
9035@kindex maint list psymtabs
9036@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
9037@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9038@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9039@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9040@item maint list symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9041@itemx maint list psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9042
9043List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
9044structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
9045given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
9046copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
9047structure in more detail. For example:
9048
9049@smallexample
9050(@value{GDBP}) maint list psymtabs dwarf2read
9051@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9052 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
9053 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
9054 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
9055 readin no
9056 fullname (null)
9057 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
9058 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
9059 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
9060 dependencies (none)
9061 @}
9062@}
9063(@value{GDBP}) maint list symtabs
9064(@value{GDBP})
9065@end smallexample
9066@noindent
9067We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
9068the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
9069and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
9070If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
9071read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
9072
9073@smallexample
9074(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
9075Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
9076line 1574.
9077(@value{GDBP}) maint list symtabs
9078@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9079 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
9080 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
9081 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
9082 dirname (null)
9083 fullname (null)
9084 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
9085 debugformat DWARF 2
9086 @}
9087@}
9088(@value{GDBP})
9089@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9090@end table
9091
44ea7b70 9092
6d2ebf8b 9093@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9094@chapter Altering Execution
9095
9096Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9097find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9098correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9099experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9100program.
9101
9102For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9103locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9104address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9105
9106@menu
9107* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9108* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9109* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9110* Returning:: Returning from a function
9111* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9112* Patching:: Patching your program
9113@end menu
9114
6d2ebf8b 9115@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9116@section Assignment to variables
9117
9118@cindex assignment
9119@cindex setting variables
9120To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9121@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9122
474c8240 9123@smallexample
c906108c 9124print x=4
474c8240 9125@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9126
9127@noindent
9128stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9129value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9130@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9131information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9132
9133@kindex set variable
9134@cindex variables, setting
9135If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9136@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9137really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9138not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9139,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9140
c906108c
SS
9141If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9142appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9143variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9144to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9145program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9146a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9147command @code{set width}:
9148
474c8240 9149@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9150(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9151type = double
9152(@value{GDBP}) p width
9153$4 = 13
9154(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9155Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9157
9158@noindent
9159The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9160order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9161
474c8240 9162@smallexample
c906108c 9163(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9164@end smallexample
53a5351d 9165
c906108c
SS
9166Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9167with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9168@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9169your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9170to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9171the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9172
474c8240 9173@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9174@group
9175(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9176type = double
9177(@value{GDBP}) p g
9178$1 = 1
9179(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9180(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9181$2 = 1
9182(@value{GDBP}) r
9183The program being debugged has been started already.
9184Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9185Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9186"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9187 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9188(@value{GDBP}) show g
9189The current BFD target is "=4".
9190@end group
474c8240 9191@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9192
9193@noindent
9194The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9195@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9196@code{g}, use
9197
474c8240 9198@smallexample
c906108c 9199(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9200@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9201
9202@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9203freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9204and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9205same length or shorter.
9206@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9207@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9208
9209To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9210construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9211(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9212to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9213and representation in memory), and
9214
474c8240 9215@smallexample
c906108c 9216set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9217@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9218
9219@noindent
9220stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9221
6d2ebf8b 9222@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9223@section Continuing at a different address
9224
9225Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9226it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9227an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9228
9229@table @code
9230@kindex jump
9231@item jump @var{linespec}
9232Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9233immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9234source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9235@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9236in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9237breakpoints}.
9238
9239The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9240the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9241register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9242a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9243be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9244of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9245confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9246executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9247well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9248
9249@item jump *@var{address}
9250Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9251@end table
9252
c906108c 9253@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9254On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9255command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9256difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9257changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9258example,
c906108c 9259
474c8240 9260@smallexample
c906108c 9261set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9262@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9263
9264@noindent
9265makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9266address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9267@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9268
9269The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9270up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9271that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9272detail.
9273
c906108c 9274@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9275@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9276@section Giving your program a signal
9277
9278@table @code
9279@kindex signal
9280@item signal @var{signal}
9281Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9282signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9283signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9284SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9285
9286Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9287giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9288a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9289@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9290signal.
9291
9292@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9293after executing the command.
9294@end table
9295@c @end group
9296
9297Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9298@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9299causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9300the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9301passes the signal directly to your program.
9302
c906108c 9303
6d2ebf8b 9304@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9305@section Returning from a function
9306
9307@table @code
9308@cindex returning from a function
9309@kindex return
9310@item return
9311@itemx return @var{expression}
9312You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9313command. If you give an
9314@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9315value.
9316@end table
9317
9318When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9319(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9320discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9321be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9322
9323This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9324frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9325innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9326specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9327of functions.
9328
9329The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9330program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9331returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9332and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9333selected stack frame returns naturally.
9334
6d2ebf8b 9335@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9336@section Calling program functions
9337
9338@cindex calling functions
9339@kindex call
9340@table @code
9341@item call @var{expr}
9342Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9343returned values.
9344@end table
9345
9346You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9347execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9348with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9349is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9350
6d2ebf8b 9351@node Patching
c906108c 9352@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9353
c906108c
SS
9354@cindex patching binaries
9355@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9356@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9357
7a292a7a
SS
9358By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9359executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9360alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9361patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9362
9363If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9364explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9365want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9366repairs.
9367
9368@table @code
9369@kindex set write
9370@item set write on
9371@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9372If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9373core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9374off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9375
9376If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9377@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9378write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9379
9380@item show write
9381@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9382Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9383as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9384@end table
9385
6d2ebf8b 9386@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9387@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9388
7a292a7a
SS
9389@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9390both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9391program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9392@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9393
9394@menu
9395* Files:: Commands to specify files
5b5d99cf 9396* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
c906108c
SS
9397* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9398@end menu
9399
6d2ebf8b 9400@node Files
c906108c 9401@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9402
7a292a7a 9403@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9404@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9405
9406You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9407way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9408@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9409Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9410
9411Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9412@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9413a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9414to specify new files are useful.
9415
9416@table @code
9417@cindex executable file
9418@kindex file
9419@item file @var{filename}
9420Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9421symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9422executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9423directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9424@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9425directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9426to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9427and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9428
6d2ebf8b 9429On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9430@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9431@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9432@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9433descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9434(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9435@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9436for more information.
c906108c
SS
9437
9438@item file
9439@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9440has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9441
9442@kindex exec-file
9443@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9444Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9445in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9446if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9447discard information on the executable file.
9448
9449@kindex symbol-file
9450@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9451Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9452searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9453table and program to run from the same file.
9454
9455@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9456program's symbol table.
9457
5d161b24 9458The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9459of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9460auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9461the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9462the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9463
9464@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9465executing it once.
9466
9467When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9468understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9469generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9470other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9471Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9472using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9473optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9474
9475For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9476using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9477symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9478quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9479details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9480
9481The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9482start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9483occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9484file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9485pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9486warnings and messages}.)
9487
c906108c
SS
9488We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9489symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9490symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9491still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9492in stabs format.
9493
9494@kindex readnow
9495@cindex reading symbols immediately
9496@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9497@kindex mapped
9498@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9499@cindex saving symbol table
9500@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9501@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9502You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9503tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9504load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9505entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9506
c906108c
SS
9507If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9508@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9509cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9510file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9511from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9512than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9513program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9514starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9515
9516You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9517file has all the symbol information for your program.
9518
9519The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9520@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9521than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9522it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9523needed.
9524
9525The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9526@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9527symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9528
9529@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9530@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9531@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9532@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9533@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9534@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9535@c files.
9536
9537@kindex core
9538@kindex core-file
9539@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9540Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9541of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9542address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9543executable file itself for other parts.
9544
9545@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9546to be used.
9547
9548Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9549under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9550wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9551the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9552(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9553
c906108c
SS
9554@kindex add-symbol-file
9555@cindex dynamic linking
9556@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9557@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9558@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9559The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9560information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9561when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9562into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9563address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9564this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9565of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9566section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9567@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9568
9569The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9570originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9571@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9572thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9573instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9574
17d9d558
JB
9575@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9576@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9577@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9578@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9579@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9580Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9581executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9582relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9583information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9584
9585@itemize @bullet
9586@item
9587the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9588that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9589@item
9590every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9591been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9592@item
9593you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9594provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9595@end itemize
9596
9597@noindent
9598Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9599relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9600typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9601important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9602procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9603assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9604general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9605relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9606as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9607way.
9608
c906108c
SS
9609@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9610
9611You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9612the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9613table information for @var{filename}.
9614
9615@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9616@item add-shared-symbol-file
9617The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9618operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9619shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9620@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9621
c906108c
SS
9622@kindex section
9623@item section
5d161b24
DB
9624The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9625the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9626section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9627specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9628separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9629the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9630
9631@kindex info files
9632@kindex info target
9633@item info files
9634@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9635@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9636current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9637including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9638use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9639command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9640current ones.
9641
fe95c787
MS
9642@kindex maint info sections
9643@item maint info sections
9644Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9645is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9646displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9647offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9648@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9649may be arbitrarily combined):
9650
9651@table @code
9652@item ALLOBJ
9653Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9654@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9655Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9656@item @var{section-flags}
9657Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9658The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9659@table @code
9660@item ALLOC
9661Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9662Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9663@item LOAD
9664Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9665Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9666@item RELOC
9667Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9668@item READONLY
9669Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9670@item CODE
9671Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9672@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9673Section contains data only (no executable code).
9674@item ROM
9675Section will reside in ROM.
9676@item CONSTRUCTOR
9677Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9678@item HAS_CONTENTS
9679Section is not empty.
9680@item NEVER_LOAD
9681An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9682@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9683A notification to the linker that the section contains
9684COFF shared library information.
9685@item IS_COMMON
9686Section contains common symbols.
9687@end table
9688@end table
6763aef9
MS
9689@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9690@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9691Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9692really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9693In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9694out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9695For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9696enhancement to debugging performance.
9697
9698The default is off.
9699
9700@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9701Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9702the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9703and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9704@end table
9705
9706All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9707as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9708name and remembers it that way.
9709
c906108c 9710@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9711@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9712libraries.
53a5351d 9713
c906108c
SS
9714@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9715when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9716(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9717references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9718debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9719
9720On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9721automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9722
c906108c
SS
9723@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9724@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9725@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9726
b7209cb4
FF
9727There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9728symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9729particularly large or there are many of them.
9730
9731To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9732commands:
9733
9734@table @code
9735@kindex set auto-solib-add
9736@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9737If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9738will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9739attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9740informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9741is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9742@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9743
9744@kindex show auto-solib-add
9745@item show auto-solib-add
9746Display the current autoloading mode.
9747@end table
9748
9749To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9750command:
9751
c906108c
SS
9752@table @code
9753@kindex info sharedlibrary
9754@kindex info share
9755@item info share
9756@itemx info sharedlibrary
9757Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9758
9759@kindex sharedlibrary
9760@kindex share
9761@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9762@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9763Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9764Unix regular expression.
9765As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9766required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9767@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9768loaded.
9769@end table
9770
b7209cb4
FF
9771On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9772autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9773reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9774by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9775up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9776wish.
c906108c
SS
9777
9778Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9779loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9780@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9781automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9782
9783To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9784
9785@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9786@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9787@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9788Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9789If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9790symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9791size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9792Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9793@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9794Mb).
c906108c 9795
b7209cb4
FF
9796@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9797@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9798Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9799@end table
c906108c 9800
f5ebfba0
DJ
9801Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
9802configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
9803host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
9804copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
9805not.
9806
9807You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
9808load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
9809@value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
9810libraries.
9811
9812@table @code
9813@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
9814@item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
9815If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
9816absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
9817paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
9818@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
9819out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
9820@file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
9821
9822You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
9823configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
9824
9825@kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
9826@item show solib-absolute-prefix
9827Display the current shared library prefix.
9828
9829@kindex set solib-search-path
9830@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
9831If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
9832to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
9833@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
9834the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
9835@samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
9836set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
9837@value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
9838
9839@kindex show solib-search-path
9840@item show solib-search-path
9841Display the current shared library search path.
9842@end table
9843
5b5d99cf
JB
9844
9845@node Separate Debug Files
9846@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
9847@cindex separate debugging information files
9848@cindex debugging information in separate files
9849@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
9850@cindex debugging information directory, global
9851@cindex global debugging information directory
9852
9853@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
9854file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
9855@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
9856Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
9857than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
9858information for their executables in separate files, which users can
9859install only when they need to debug a problem.
9860
9861If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
9862separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
9863the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
9864components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
9865debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
9866containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
9867debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
9868will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
9869places:
9870
9871@itemize @bullet
9872@item
9873the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
9874for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
9875@item
9876a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
9877file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
9878@item
9879a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
9880executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
9881@file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
9882@var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
9883@var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
9884@end itemize
9885@noindent
9886@value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
9887information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
9888reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
9889
9890So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
9891which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
9892debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
9893for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
9894@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
9895@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
9896
9897You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
9898name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
9899
9900@table @code
9901
9902@kindex set debug-file-directory
9903@item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
9904Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
9905information files to @var{directory}.
9906
9907@kindex show debug-file-directory
9908@item show debug-file-directory
9909Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
9910information files.
9911
9912@end table
9913
9914@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
9915@cindex debug links
9916A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
9917@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
9918
9919@itemize
9920@item
9921A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
9922a zero byte,
9923@item
9924zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
9925boundary within the section, and
9926@item
9927a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
9928executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
9929information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
9930zero as the @var{crc} argument.
9931@end itemize
9932
9933Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
9934contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
9935described above.
9936
9937The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
9938executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
9939debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
9940should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
9941but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
9942in an ordinary executable.
9943
9944As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
9945separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
9946Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
9947contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
9948@kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
9949the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
9950@file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
9951
9952Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
9953polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
9954describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
9955complete code for a function that computes it:
9956
9957@kindex @code{gnu_debuglink_crc32}
9958@smallexample
9959unsigned long
9960gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
9961 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
9962@{
9963 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
9964 @{
9965 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
9966 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
9967 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
9968 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
9969 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
9970 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
9971 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
9972 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
9973 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
9974 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
9975 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
9976 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
9977 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
9978 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
9979 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
9980 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
9981 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
9982 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
9983 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
9984 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
9985 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
9986 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
9987 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
9988 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
9989 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
9990 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
9991 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
9992 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
9993 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
9994 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
9995 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
9996 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
9997 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
9998 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
9999 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
10000 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
10001 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
10002 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
10003 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
10004 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
10005 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
10006 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
10007 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
10008 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
10009 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
10010 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
10011 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
10012 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
10013 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
10014 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
10015 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
10016 0x2d02ef8d
10017 @};
10018 unsigned char *end;
10019
10020 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
10021 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
10022 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
10023 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;;
10024@}
10025@end smallexample
10026
10027
6d2ebf8b 10028@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
10029@section Errors reading symbol files
10030
10031While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
10032such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
10033output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
10034they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
10035debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
10036about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
10037only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
10038times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
10039to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
10040complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10041messages}).
10042
10043The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
10044
10045@table @code
10046@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
10047
10048The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
10049(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
10050error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
10051in its outer scope blocks.
10052
10053@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
10054the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
10055may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10056function.
10057
10058@item block at @var{address} out of order
10059
10060The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10061order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10062do so.
10063
10064@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10065locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10066can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10067@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10068messages}.)
10069
10070@item bad block start address patched
10071
10072The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10073smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10074to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10075
10076@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10077starting on the previous source line.
10078
10079@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10080
10081@cindex foo
10082Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10083larger than the size of the string table.
10084
10085@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10086name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10087with this name.
10088
10089@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10090
7a292a7a
SS
10091The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10092not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 10093uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 10094
7a292a7a
SS
10095@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10096This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 10097are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
10098debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10099on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10100and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
10101
10102@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 10103
7a292a7a 10104@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 10105
7a292a7a 10106@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 10107The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
10108information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10109it.
c906108c
SS
10110
10111@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10112
10113@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 10114
c906108c
SS
10115@end table
10116
6d2ebf8b 10117@node Targets
c906108c 10118@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 10119
c906108c
SS
10120@cindex debugging target
10121@kindex target
10122
10123A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
10124
10125Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10126in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10127you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
10128flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10129host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
10130realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10131command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10132(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
10133
10134@menu
10135* Active Targets:: Active targets
10136* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
10137* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10138* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 10139* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
10140
10141@end menu
10142
6d2ebf8b 10143@node Active Targets
c906108c 10144@section Active targets
7a292a7a 10145
c906108c
SS
10146@cindex stacking targets
10147@cindex active targets
10148@cindex multiple targets
10149
c906108c 10150There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
10151executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10152active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10153start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10154a core file.
c906108c
SS
10155
10156For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10157@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10158well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10159@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10160first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10161requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10162are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10163read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10164executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
10165
10166When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
10167target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10168commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10169an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10170process target is active.
c906108c 10171
7a292a7a
SS
10172Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10173core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 10174files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
10175the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10176process}).
c906108c 10177
6d2ebf8b 10178@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
10179@section Commands for managing targets
10180
10181@table @code
10182@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
10183Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10184process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10185facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10186protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
10187
10188Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10189typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10190with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
10191
10192The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10193after executing the command.
10194
10195@kindex help target
10196@item help target
10197Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10198currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10199(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10200
10201@item help target @var{name}
10202Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10203select it.
10204
10205@kindex set gnutarget
10206@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 10207@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 10208knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
10209a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10210with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
10211with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10212
d4f3574e 10213@quotation
c906108c
SS
10214@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10215you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 10216@end quotation
c906108c 10217
d4f3574e
SS
10218@noindent
10219@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 10220
5d161b24 10221@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
10222@item show gnutarget
10223Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10224@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10225@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10226and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10227@end table
10228
c906108c
SS
10229Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10230configuration):
c906108c
SS
10231
10232@table @code
10233@kindex target exec
10234@item target exec @var{program}
10235An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10236@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10237
c906108c
SS
10238@kindex target core
10239@item target core @var{filename}
10240A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10241@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
10242
10243@kindex target remote
10244@item target remote @var{dev}
10245Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10246specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10247@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10248supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
10249some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10250it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10251
c906108c
SS
10252@kindex target sim
10253@item target sim
2df3850c 10254Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 10255In general,
474c8240 10256@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10257 target sim
10258 load
10259 run
474c8240 10260@end smallexample
d4f3574e 10261@noindent
104c1213 10262works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 10263drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
10264provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10265see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10266Processors}.
10267
c906108c
SS
10268@end table
10269
104c1213 10270Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
10271
10272@table @code
10273
c906108c
SS
10274@kindex target nrom
10275@item target nrom @var{dev}
10276NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10277
c906108c
SS
10278@end table
10279
5d161b24 10280Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 10281your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
10282
10283Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10284once you've successfully established a connection.
10285
10286@table @code
10287
10288@kindex load @var{filename}
10289@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
10290Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10291@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10292is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10293on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10294@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10295the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10296
10297If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10298execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10299target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
10300
10301The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10302For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10303link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10304specifies a fixed address.
10305@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10306
c906108c
SS
10307@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10308@end table
10309
6d2ebf8b 10310@node Byte Order
c906108c 10311@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10312
c906108c
SS
10313@cindex choosing target byte order
10314@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
10315
10316Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10317offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10318orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10319designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10320which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10321@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10322
10323@table @code
10324@kindex set endian big
10325@item set endian big
10326Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10327
10328@kindex set endian little
10329@item set endian little
10330Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10331
10332@kindex set endian auto
10333@item set endian auto
10334Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10335executable.
10336
10337@item show endian
10338Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10339
10340@end table
10341
10342Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10343data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10344target system.
10345
6d2ebf8b 10346@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10347@section Remote debugging
10348@cindex remote debugging
10349
10350If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10351@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10352For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10353or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10354powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10355
10356Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10357to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10358@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10359but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10360write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10361communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10362
10363Other remote targets may be available in your
10364configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10365
6f05cf9f
AC
10366@node KOD
10367@section Kernel Object Display
10368
10369@cindex kernel object display
10370@cindex kernel object
10371@cindex KOD
10372
10373Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10374@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10375and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10376mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10377displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10378
10379Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10380@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10381
474c8240 10382@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10383(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10384@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10385
10386If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10387about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10388which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10389after the operating system:
c906108c 10390
474c8240 10391@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10392(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10393List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10394Object Description
10395any Any and all objects
474c8240 10396@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10397
10398Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10399by the kernel.
10400
10401There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10402is supported other than to try it.
10403
10404
10405@node Remote Debugging
10406@chapter Debugging remote programs
10407
6b2f586d
AC
10408@menu
10409* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10410* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
501eef12 10411* Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
6b2f586d 10412* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10413@end menu
10414
6f05cf9f
AC
10415@node Server
10416@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10417
10418@kindex gdbserver
10419@cindex remote connection without stubs
10420@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10421allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10422@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10423
10424@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10425because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10426that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10427@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10428@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10429because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10430also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10431started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10432Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10433the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10434do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10435by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10436choice for debugging.
10437
10438@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10439or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10440protocol.
10441
10442@table @emph
10443@item On the target machine,
10444you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10445@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10446strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10447system does all the symbol handling.
10448
10449To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10450the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10451syntax is:
10452
10453@smallexample
10454target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10455@end smallexample
10456
10457@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10458hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10459@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10460@file{/dev/com1}:
10461
10462@smallexample
10463target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10464@end smallexample
10465
10466@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10467with it.
10468
10469To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10470
10471@smallexample
10472target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10473@end smallexample
10474
10475The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10476specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10477TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10478expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10479(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10480you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10481TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10482reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10483conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10484and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10485@code{target remote} command.
10486
56460a61
DJ
10487On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10488This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10489
10490@smallexample
10491target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10492@end smallexample
10493
10494@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10495to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10496
6f05cf9f
AC
10497@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10498you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10499symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10500using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10501(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10502running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10503remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10504is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10505@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10506@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10507
10508@smallexample
10509(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10510@end smallexample
10511
10512@noindent
10513communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10514
10515@smallexample
10516(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10517@end smallexample
10518
10519@noindent
10520communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10521For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10522the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10523text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10524@samp{Connection refused}.
10525@end table
10526
10527@node NetWare
10528@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10529
10530@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10531@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10532allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10533@code{target remote}.
10534
10535@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10536using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10537
10538@table @emph
10539@item On the target machine,
10540you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10541@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10542can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10543host system does all the symbol handling.
10544
10545To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10546@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10547program. The syntax is:
10548
10549@smallexample
10550load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10551 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10552@end smallexample
10553
10554@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10555the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10556to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10557
10558For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10559communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10560using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10561
10562@smallexample
10563load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10564@end smallexample
10565
10566@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10567you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10568symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10569using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10570(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10571running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10572remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10573argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10574@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10575
10576@smallexample
10577(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10578@end smallexample
10579
10580@noindent
10581communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10582@end table
10583
501eef12
AC
10584@node Remote configuration
10585@section Remote configuration
10586
10587The following configuration options are available when debugging remote
10588programs:
10589
10590@table @code
10591@kindex set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
10592@kindex set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
10593@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
10594@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
10595@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
10596@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
10597Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
10598watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
10599@end table
10600
6f05cf9f
AC
10601@node remote stub
10602@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10603
8e04817f
AC
10604@cindex debugging stub, example
10605@cindex remote stub, example
10606@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10607The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10608communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10609@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10610these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10611implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10612with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10613organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10614
104c1213
JM
10615@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10616To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10617@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10618prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10619program, you need:
c906108c 10620
104c1213
JM
10621@enumerate
10622@item
10623A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10624have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10625your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10626
5d161b24 10627@item
d4f3574e 10628A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10629subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10630
104c1213
JM
10631@item
10632A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10633download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10634manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10635documentation.
10636@end enumerate
96baa820 10637
104c1213
JM
10638The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10639communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10640machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10641
104c1213
JM
10642@table @emph
10643@item On the host,
10644@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10645else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10646(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10647
10648@item On the target,
10649you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10650implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10651subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10652
10653On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10654@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10655@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10656@end table
96baa820 10657
104c1213
JM
10658The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10659machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10660@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10661
104c1213
JM
10662@cindex remote serial stub list
10663These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10664
104c1213
JM
10665@table @code
10666
10667@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10668@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10669@cindex Intel
10670@cindex i386
10671For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10672
10673@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10674@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10675@cindex Motorola 680x0
10676@cindex m680x0
10677For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10678
10679@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10680@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10681@cindex Hitachi
10682@cindex SH
10683For Hitachi SH architectures.
10684
10685@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10686@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10687@cindex Sparc
10688For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10689
10690@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10691@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10692@cindex Fujitsu
10693@cindex SparcLite
10694For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10695
10696@end table
10697
10698The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10699recently added stubs.
10700
10701@menu
10702* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10703* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10704* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10705@end menu
10706
6d2ebf8b 10707@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10708@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10709
10710@cindex remote serial stub
10711The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10712subroutines:
10713
10714@table @code
10715@item set_debug_traps
10716@kindex set_debug_traps
10717@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10718This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10719program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10720beginning of your program.
10721
10722@item handle_exception
10723@kindex handle_exception
10724@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10725This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10726explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10727run when a trap is triggered.
10728
10729@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10730execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10731with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10732protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10733representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10734information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10735retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10736execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10737@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10738machine.
104c1213
JM
10739
10740@item breakpoint
10741@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10742Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10743breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10744way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10745machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10746pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10747@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10748simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10749again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10750your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10751@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10752
10753Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10754to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10755start of your debugging session.
10756@end table
10757
6d2ebf8b 10758@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10759@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10760
10761@cindex remote stub, support routines
10762The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10763chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10764debugging target machine.
10765
10766First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10767serial port.
10768
10769@table @code
10770@item int getDebugChar()
10771@kindex getDebugChar
10772Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10773It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10774different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10775
10776@item void putDebugChar(int)
10777@kindex putDebugChar
10778Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10779It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10780different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10781@end table
10782
10783@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10784@cindex interrupting remote targets
10785If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10786running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10787for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10788character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10789remote system to stop.
10790
10791Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10792probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10793is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10794@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10795
10796Other routines you need to supply are:
10797
10798@table @code
10799@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10800@kindex exceptionHandler
10801Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10802handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10803way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10804are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10805containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10806@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10807its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10808might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10809exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10810@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10811and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10812you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10813should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10814
10815For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10816gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10817should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10818@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10819help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10820
10821@item void flush_i_cache()
10822@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10823On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10824instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10825instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10826
10827On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10828function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10829@end table
10830
10831@noindent
10832You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10833
10834@table @code
10835@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10836@kindex memset
10837This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10838memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10839@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10840either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10841@end table
10842
10843If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10844library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10845but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10846subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10847
10848
6d2ebf8b 10849@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10850@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10851
10852@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10853In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10854steps.
10855
10856@enumerate
10857@item
6d2ebf8b 10858Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10859(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10860@display
10861@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10862@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10863@end display
10864
10865@item
10866Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10867
474c8240 10868@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10869set_debug_traps();
10870breakpoint();
474c8240 10871@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10872
10873@item
10874For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10875@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10876
474c8240 10877@smallexample
104c1213 10878void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10879@end smallexample
104c1213 10880
d4f3574e 10881@noindent
104c1213 10882but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10883function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10884@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10885error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10886one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10887
10888@item
10889Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10890your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10891
10892@item
10893Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10894the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10895
10896@item
10897@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10898@c document that. FIXME.
10899Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10900whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10901
10902@item
10903To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10904as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10905This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10906of its pure text.
10907
d4f3574e 10908@item
104c1213 10909@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10910Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10911Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10912machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10913TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10914to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10915device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10916
474c8240 10917@smallexample
104c1213 10918target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10919@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10920
10921@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10922To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10923@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10924For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10925terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10926
474c8240 10927@smallexample
104c1213 10928target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10929@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10930
10931If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10932your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10933the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10934to port 1234 on your local machine:
10935
474c8240 10936@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10937target remote :1234
474c8240 10938@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10939@noindent
10940
10941Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10942
10943@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10944To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10945@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10946on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10947
10948@smallexample
10949target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10950@end smallexample
10951
10952When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10953that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10954busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10955session.
10956
104c1213
JM
10957@end enumerate
10958
10959Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10960step and continue the remote program.
10961
10962To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10963command.
10964
10965@cindex interrupting remote programs
10966@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10967Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10968interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10969program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10970and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10971interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10972
474c8240 10973@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10974Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10975Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10976@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10977
10978If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10979(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10980remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10981goes back to waiting.
10982
104c1213 10983
8e04817f
AC
10984@node Configurations
10985@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10986
8e04817f
AC
10987While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10988cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10989describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10990
8e04817f
AC
10991There are three major categories of configurations: native
10992configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10993operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10994different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10995are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10996
8e04817f
AC
10997@menu
10998* Native::
10999* Embedded OS::
11000* Embedded Processors::
11001* Architectures::
11002@end menu
104c1213 11003
8e04817f
AC
11004@node Native
11005@section Native
104c1213 11006
8e04817f
AC
11007This section describes details specific to particular native
11008configurations.
6cf7e474 11009
8e04817f
AC
11010@menu
11011* HP-UX:: HP-UX
11012* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
11013* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 11014* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 11015@end menu
6cf7e474 11016
8e04817f
AC
11017@node HP-UX
11018@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 11019
8e04817f
AC
11020On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
11021begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
11022name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 11023
8e04817f
AC
11024@node SVR4 Process Information
11025@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 11026
8e04817f
AC
11027@kindex /proc
11028@cindex process image
104c1213 11029
8e04817f
AC
11030Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
11031used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
11032subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
11033this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
11034several kinds of information about the process running your program.
11035@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
11036@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
1104b9e7 11037and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
104c1213 11038
8e04817f
AC
11039@table @code
11040@kindex info proc
11041@item info proc
11042Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 11043
8e04817f
AC
11044@kindex info proc mappings
11045@item info proc mappings
11046Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
11047on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
11048@ignore
11049@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
11050@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
11051@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
11052@kindex info proc times
11053@item info proc times
11054Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11055its children.
6cf7e474 11056
8e04817f
AC
11057@kindex info proc id
11058@item info proc id
11059Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11060the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 11061
8e04817f
AC
11062@kindex info proc status
11063@item info proc status
11064General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11065stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11066received.
d4f3574e 11067
8e04817f
AC
11068@item info proc all
11069Show all the above information about the process.
11070@end ignore
11071@end table
104c1213 11072
8e04817f
AC
11073@node DJGPP Native
11074@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11075@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11076@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11077@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 11078
8e04817f
AC
11079@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11080MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11081that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11082top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 11083
8e04817f
AC
11084@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11085defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11086subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 11087
8e04817f
AC
11088@table @code
11089@kindex info dos
11090@item info dos
11091This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11092information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 11093
8e04817f
AC
11094@kindex sysinfo
11095@cindex MS-DOS system info
11096@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11097@item info dos sysinfo
11098This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11099platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11100DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 11101
8e04817f
AC
11102@cindex GDT
11103@cindex LDT
11104@cindex IDT
11105@cindex segment descriptor tables
11106@cindex descriptor tables display
11107@item info dos gdt
11108@itemx info dos ldt
11109@itemx info dos idt
11110These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11111and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11112tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11113that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11114descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11115descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11116rights.
104c1213 11117
8e04817f
AC
11118A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11119segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11120allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11121conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11122additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 11123
8e04817f
AC
11124@cindex garbled pointers
11125These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11126Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11127displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11128display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11129example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11130debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 11131
8e04817f
AC
11132@smallexample
11133@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11134@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11135@end smallexample
104c1213 11136
8e04817f
AC
11137@noindent
11138This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11139the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 11140
8e04817f
AC
11141@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11142@item info dos pde
11143@itemx info dos pte
11144These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11145Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11146data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11147into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11148page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11149may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11150Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11151that is currently in use.
104c1213 11152
8e04817f
AC
11153Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11154Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11155the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11156@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11157Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11158means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11159the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 11160
8e04817f
AC
11161@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11162These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11163Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11164controller.
104c1213 11165
8e04817f 11166These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 11167
8e04817f
AC
11168@cindex physical address from linear address
11169@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11170This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11171address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11172appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11173accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11174example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11175the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 11176
8e04817f
AC
11177@smallexample
11178@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11179@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11180@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11181@end smallexample
104c1213 11182
8e04817f
AC
11183@noindent
11184This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11185whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11186attributes of that page.
104c1213 11187
8e04817f
AC
11188Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11189since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11190address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11191be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11192declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11193@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 11194
8e04817f
AC
11195Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11196transfer buffer:
104c1213 11197
8e04817f
AC
11198@smallexample
11199@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11200@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11201@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11202@end smallexample
104c1213 11203
8e04817f
AC
11204@noindent
11205(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
112063rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11207this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11208mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 11209
8e04817f
AC
11210This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11211@end table
104c1213 11212
78c47bea
PM
11213@node Cygwin Native
11214@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11215@cindex MS Windows debugging
11216@cindex native Cygwin debugging
11217@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11218
be448670
CF
11219@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
11220DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
11221additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
11222subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
11223that have no debugging symbols.
11224
78c47bea
PM
11225
11226@table @code
11227@kindex info w32
11228@item info w32
11229This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11230information about the target system and important OS structures.
11231
11232@item info w32 selector
11233This command displays information returned by
11234the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11235It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11236a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11237Without argument, this command displays information
11238about the the six segment registers.
11239
11240@kindex info dll
11241@item info dll
11242This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11243
11244@kindex dll-symbols
11245@item dll-symbols
11246This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11247add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11248
11249@kindex set new-console
11250@item set new-console @var{mode}
11251If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11252be started in a new console on next start.
11253If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11254be started in the same console as the debugger.
11255
11256@kindex show new-console
11257@item show new-console
11258Displays whether a new console is used
11259when the debuggee is started.
11260
11261@kindex set new-group
11262@item set new-group @var{mode}
11263This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11264start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11265This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11266Ctrl-C.
11267
11268@kindex show new-group
11269@item show new-group
11270Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11271
11272@kindex set debugevents
11273@item set debugevents
11274This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11275
11276@kindex set debugexec
11277@item set debugexec
11278This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11279seen by the debugger.
11280
11281@kindex set debugexceptions
11282@item set debugexceptions
11283This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11284seen by the debugger.
11285
11286@kindex set debugmemory
11287@item set debugmemory
11288This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11289seen by the debugger.
11290
11291@kindex set shell
11292@item set shell
11293This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11294via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11295
11296@kindex show shell
11297@item show shell
11298Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11299
11300@end table
11301
be448670
CF
11302@menu
11303* Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11304@end menu
11305
11306@node Non-debug DLL symbols
11307@subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11308@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
11309@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
11310
11311Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
11312not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
11313@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
11314symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
11315information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
11316describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
11317``minimal symbols''.
11318
11319Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
11320will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
11321start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
11322program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
11323@value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
11324see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
11325@code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
11326explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
11327cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
11328which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
11329
11330@subsubsection DLL name prefixes
11331
11332In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
11333tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
11334DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
11335also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
11336sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
11337(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
11338necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
11339contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
11340exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
11341
11342Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
11343though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
11344symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
11345some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
11346@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
11347@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
11348
11349@smallexample
11350(gdb) info function CreateFileA
11351All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
11352
11353Non-debugging symbols:
113540x77e885f4 CreateFileA
113550x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
11356@end smallexample
11357
11358@smallexample
11359(gdb) info function !
11360All functions matching regular expression "!":
11361
11362Non-debugging symbols:
113630x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
113640x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
113650x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
11366[etc...]
11367@end smallexample
11368
11369@subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
11370
11371Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
11372type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
11373refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
11374contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
11375contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
11376means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
11377a function within a DLL without a running program.
11378
11379Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
11380automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
11381variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
11382type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
11383problem:
11384
11385@smallexample
11386(gdb) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
11387$1 = 268572168
11388@end smallexample
11389
11390@smallexample
11391(gdb) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
113920x10021610: "\230y\""
11393@end smallexample
11394
11395And two possible solutions:
11396
11397@smallexample
11398(gdb) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
11399$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11400@end smallexample
11401
11402@smallexample
11403(gdb) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
114040x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
11405(gdb) x/x 0x10021608
114060x10021608: 0x0022fd98
11407(gdb) x/s 0x0022fd98
114080x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11409@end smallexample
11410
11411Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
11412starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
11413examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
11414function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
11415to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
11416
11417@smallexample
11418(gdb) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
11419Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
11420@end smallexample
11421
11422The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
11423break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
11424safe.
11425
8e04817f
AC
11426@node Embedded OS
11427@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 11428
8e04817f
AC
11429This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11430embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11431architectures.
d4f3574e 11432
8e04817f
AC
11433@menu
11434* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11435@end menu
104c1213 11436
8e04817f
AC
11437@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11438various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 11439
8e04817f
AC
11440@node VxWorks
11441@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 11442
8e04817f 11443@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 11444
8e04817f 11445@table @code
104c1213 11446
8e04817f
AC
11447@kindex target vxworks
11448@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11449A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11450is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 11451
8e04817f 11452@end table
104c1213 11453
8e04817f
AC
11454On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11455current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11456
8e04817f
AC
11457@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11458VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11459the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11460both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11461@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11462installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11463@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11464
8e04817f
AC
11465@table @code
11466@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11467@kindex vxworks-timeout
11468All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11469This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11470seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11471your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11472of a thin network line.
11473@end table
104c1213 11474
8e04817f
AC
11475The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11476this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11477procedures.
104c1213 11478
8e04817f
AC
11479@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11480To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11481to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11482library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11483VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11484kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11485source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11486information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11487manual.
11488@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11489
8e04817f
AC
11490Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11491your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11492run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11493@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11494
8e04817f 11495@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11496
474c8240 11497@smallexample
8e04817f 11498(vxgdb)
474c8240 11499@end smallexample
104c1213 11500
8e04817f
AC
11501@menu
11502* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11503* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11504* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11505@end menu
104c1213 11506
8e04817f
AC
11507@node VxWorks Connection
11508@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11509
8e04817f
AC
11510The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11511network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11512
474c8240 11513@smallexample
8e04817f 11514(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11515@end smallexample
104c1213 11516
8e04817f
AC
11517@need 750
11518@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11519
8e04817f
AC
11520@smallexample
11521Attaching remote machine across net...
11522Connected to tt.
11523@end smallexample
104c1213 11524
8e04817f
AC
11525@need 1000
11526@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11527loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11528these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11529path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11530to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11531
474c8240 11532@smallexample
8e04817f 11533prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11534@end smallexample
104c1213 11535
8e04817f
AC
11536When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11537the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11538command again.
104c1213 11539
8e04817f
AC
11540@node VxWorks Download
11541@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11542
8e04817f
AC
11543@cindex download to VxWorks
11544If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11545object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11546@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11547incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11548command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11549to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11550table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11551the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11552filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11553Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11554to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11555the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11556@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11557and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11558program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11559
474c8240 11560@smallexample
8e04817f 11561-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11562@end smallexample
104c1213 11563
8e04817f
AC
11564@noindent
11565Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11566
474c8240 11567@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11568(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11569(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11570@end smallexample
104c1213 11571
8e04817f 11572@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11573
8e04817f
AC
11574@smallexample
11575Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11576@end smallexample
104c1213 11577
8e04817f
AC
11578You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11579after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11580this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11581auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11582history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11583debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11584table.)
104c1213 11585
8e04817f
AC
11586@node VxWorks Attach
11587@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11588
11589@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11590You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11591follows:
11592
474c8240 11593@smallexample
104c1213 11594(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11595@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11596
11597@noindent
11598where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11599or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11600the time of attachment.
11601
6d2ebf8b 11602@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11603@section Embedded Processors
11604
11605This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11606configurations.
11607
7d86b5d5 11608
104c1213 11609@menu
104c1213
JM
11610* ARM:: ARM
11611* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11612* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
104c1213
JM
11613* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11614* M68K:: Motorola M68K
104c1213 11615* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
a37295f9 11616* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
104c1213
JM
11617* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11618* PowerPC: PowerPC
11619* SH:: Hitachi SH
11620* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11621* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11622* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11623* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11624@end menu
11625
6d2ebf8b 11626@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11627@subsection ARM
11628
11629@table @code
11630
8e04817f
AC
11631@kindex target rdi
11632@item target rdi @var{dev}
11633ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11634use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11635monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11636
11637@kindex target rdp
11638@item target rdp @var{dev}
11639ARM Demon monitor.
11640
11641@end table
11642
11643@node H8/300
11644@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11645
11646@table @code
11647
11648@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11649@item target hms @var{dev}
11650A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11651Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11652line and the communications speed used.
11653
11654@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11655@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11656E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11657
11658@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11659@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11660@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11661@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11662Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11663
11664@end table
11665
11666@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11667@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11668@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11669@cindex Hitachi SH download
11670When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11671board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11672board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11673@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11674
11675@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11676Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11677
11678@enumerate
11679@item
11680that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11681for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11682emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11683the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11684H8/300, or H8/500.)
11685
11686@item
11687what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11688serial device available on your host is the default).
11689
11690@item
11691what speed to use over the serial device.
11692@end enumerate
11693
11694@menu
11695* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11696* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11697* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11698@end menu
11699
11700@node Hitachi Boards
11701@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11702
11703@c only for Unix hosts
11704@kindex device
11705@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11706Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11707need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11708first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11709hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11710
11711@kindex speed
11712@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11713@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11714speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11715hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11716the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11717@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11718
11719The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11720use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11721use a DOS host,
11722@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11723called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11724through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11725to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11726
11727The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11728program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11729sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11730the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11731
11732First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11733board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11734port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11735When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11736debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11737for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11738@code{COM2}.
11739
474c8240 11740@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11741C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11742C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11743
11744Resident portion of MODE loaded
11745
11746COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11747
474c8240 11748@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11749
11750@quotation
11751@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11752@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11753disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11754your development board.
11755@end quotation
11756
11757@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11758Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11759connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11760the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11761you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11762commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11763cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11764download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11765the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11766(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11767executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11768@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11769itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11770
11771@smallexample
11772(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11773@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11774 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11775 the conditions.
11776There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11777for details.
11778@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11779(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11780Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11781(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11782.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11783.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11784.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11785@end smallexample
11786
11787At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11788you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11789sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11790@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11791resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11792@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11793
11794Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11795available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11796you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11797
11798Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11799@itemize @bullet
11800@item
11801to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11802no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11803
11804@item
11805to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11806normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11807to detect program completion.
11808@end itemize
11809
11810In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11811development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11812
11813@node Hitachi ICE
11814@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11815
11816@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11817You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11818Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11819e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11820
11821@table @code
11822@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11823Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11824@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11825@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11826(for example, @samp{9600}).
11827
11828@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11829If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11830specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11831@end table
11832
11833@node Hitachi Special
11834@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11835
11836Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11837
11838@table @code
11839
11840@kindex set machine
11841@kindex show machine
11842@item set machine h8300
11843@itemx set machine h8300h
11844Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11845architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11846to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11847
11848@end table
11849
8e04817f
AC
11850@node H8/500
11851@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11852
11853@table @code
11854
8e04817f
AC
11855@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11856@cindex memory models, H8/500
11857@item set memory @var{mod}
11858@itemx show memory
11859Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11860@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11861memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11862@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11863
8e04817f 11864@end table
104c1213 11865
8e04817f
AC
11866@node M32R/D
11867@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11868
11869@table @code
11870
11871@kindex target m32r
11872@item target m32r @var{dev}
11873Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11874
11875@end table
11876
11877@node M68K
11878@subsection M68k
11879
11880The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11881target command for the following ROM monitors.
11882
11883@table @code
11884
11885@kindex target abug
11886@item target abug @var{dev}
11887ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11888
11889@kindex target cpu32bug
11890@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11891CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11892
11893@kindex target dbug
11894@item target dbug @var{dev}
11895dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11896
11897@kindex target est
11898@item target est @var{dev}
11899EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11900
11901@kindex target rom68k
11902@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11903ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11904
11905@end table
11906
8e04817f
AC
11907@table @code
11908
11909@kindex target rombug
11910@item target rombug @var{dev}
11911ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11912
11913@end table
11914
8e04817f
AC
11915@node MIPS Embedded
11916@subsection MIPS Embedded
11917
11918@cindex MIPS boards
11919@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11920MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11921you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11922
8e04817f
AC
11923@need 1000
11924Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11925
8e04817f
AC
11926@table @code
11927@item target mips @var{port}
11928@kindex target mips @var{port}
11929To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11930name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11931command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11932the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11933been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11934download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11935
8e04817f
AC
11936For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11937port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11938debugger:
104c1213 11939
474c8240 11940@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11941host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11942@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11943(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11944(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11945(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11946@end smallexample
104c1213 11947
8e04817f
AC
11948@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11949On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11950connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11951concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11952@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11953
8e04817f
AC
11954@item target pmon @var{port}
11955@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11956PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11957
8e04817f
AC
11958@item target ddb @var{port}
11959@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11960NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11961
8e04817f
AC
11962@item target lsi @var{port}
11963@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11964LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11965
8e04817f
AC
11966@kindex target r3900
11967@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11968Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11969
8e04817f
AC
11970@kindex target array
11971@item target array @var{dev}
11972Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11973
8e04817f 11974@end table
104c1213 11975
104c1213 11976
8e04817f
AC
11977@noindent
11978@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11979
8e04817f
AC
11980@table @code
11981@item set processor @var{args}
11982@itemx show processor
11983@kindex set processor @var{args}
11984@kindex show processor
11985Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11986processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11987For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11988to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11989Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11990is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11991@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11992
8e04817f
AC
11993@item set mipsfpu double
11994@itemx set mipsfpu single
11995@itemx set mipsfpu none
11996@itemx show mipsfpu
11997@kindex set mipsfpu
11998@kindex show mipsfpu
11999@cindex MIPS remote floating point
12000@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
12001If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
12002coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
12003need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
12004file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
12005functions which return floating point values. It also allows
12006@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
12007functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
12008with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
12009processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
12010double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
12011@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 12012
8e04817f
AC
12013In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
12014floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12015and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 12016
8e04817f
AC
12017As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12018@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 12019
8e04817f
AC
12020@item set remotedebug @var{n}
12021@itemx show remotedebug
12022@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12023@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12024@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12025@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12026@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12027@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12028You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12029by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12030@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12031to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12032at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 12033
8e04817f
AC
12034@item set timeout @var{seconds}
12035@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12036@itemx show timeout
12037@itemx show retransmit-timeout
12038@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12039@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12040@kindex set timeout
12041@kindex show timeout
12042@kindex set retransmit-timeout
12043@kindex show retransmit-timeout
12044You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12045remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12046default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12047waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12048retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12049You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12050retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12051@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 12052
8e04817f
AC
12053The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12054is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12055forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12056to run before stopping.
12057@end table
104c1213 12058
a37295f9
MM
12059@node OpenRISC 1000
12060@subsection OpenRISC 1000
12061@cindex OpenRISC 1000
12062
12063@cindex or1k boards
12064See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
12065about platform and commands.
12066
12067@table @code
12068
12069@kindex target jtag
12070@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
12071
12072Connects to remote JTAG server.
12073JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
12074connected via parallel port to the board.
12075
12076Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
12077
12078@kindex or1ksim
12079@item or1ksim @var{command}
12080If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
12081Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
12082
12083@kindex info or1k spr
12084@item info or1k spr
12085Displays spr groups.
12086
12087@item info or1k spr @var{group}
12088@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
12089Displays register names in selected group.
12090
12091@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
12092@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
12093@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
12094@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
12095Shows information about specified spr register.
12096
12097@kindex spr
12098@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
12099@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
12100@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
12101@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
12102Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
12103@end table
12104
12105Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
12106It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
12107program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
12108triggers can be set using:
12109@table @code
12110@item $LEA/$LDATA
12111Load effective address/data
12112@item $SEA/$SDATA
12113Store effective address/data
12114@item $AEA/$ADATA
12115Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
12116@item $FETCH
12117Fetch data
12118@end table
12119
12120When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
12121@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
12122
12123@code{htrace} commands:
12124@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
12125@table @code
12126@kindex hwatch
12127@item hwatch @var{conditional}
12128Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
12129or Data. For example:
12130
12131@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12132
12133@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12134
12135@kindex htrace info
12136@item htrace info
12137Display information about current HW trace configuration.
12138
12139@kindex htrace trigger
12140@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
12141Set starting criteria for HW trace.
12142
12143@kindex htrace qualifier
12144@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
12145Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
12146
12147@kindex htrace stop
12148@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
12149Set HW trace stopping criteria.
12150
12151@kindex htrace record
f153cc92 12152@item htrace record [@var{data}]*
a37295f9
MM
12153Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
12154triggered.
12155
12156@kindex htrace enable
12157@item htrace enable
12158@kindex htrace disable
12159@itemx htrace disable
12160Enables/disables the HW trace.
12161
12162@kindex htrace rewind
f153cc92 12163@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
a37295f9
MM
12164Clears currently recorded trace data.
12165
12166If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
12167will be written there.
12168
12169@kindex htrace print
f153cc92 12170@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
a37295f9
MM
12171Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
12172
12173@kindex htrace mode continuous
12174@item htrace mode continuous
12175Set continuous trace mode.
12176
12177@kindex htrace mode suspend
12178@item htrace mode suspend
12179Set suspend trace mode.
12180
12181@end table
12182
8e04817f
AC
12183@node PowerPC
12184@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
12185
12186@table @code
104c1213 12187
8e04817f
AC
12188@kindex target dink32
12189@item target dink32 @var{dev}
12190DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 12191
8e04817f
AC
12192@kindex target ppcbug
12193@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12194@kindex target ppcbug1
12195@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12196PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 12197
8e04817f
AC
12198@kindex target sds
12199@item target sds @var{dev}
12200SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12201
12202@end table
12203
12204@node PA
12205@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
12206
12207@table @code
12208
8e04817f
AC
12209@kindex target op50n
12210@item target op50n @var{dev}
12211OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12212
12213@kindex target w89k
12214@item target w89k @var{dev}
12215W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
12216
12217@end table
12218
8e04817f
AC
12219@node SH
12220@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
12221
12222@table @code
12223
8e04817f
AC
12224@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12225@item target hms @var{dev}
12226A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12227commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12228the communications speed used.
104c1213 12229
8e04817f
AC
12230@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12231@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12232E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 12233
8e04817f
AC
12234@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12235@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12236@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12237@item target sh3e @var{dev}
12238Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 12239
8e04817f 12240@end table
104c1213 12241
8e04817f
AC
12242@node Sparclet
12243@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 12244
8e04817f
AC
12245@cindex Sparclet
12246
12247@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12248Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12249@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12250both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12251@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 12252
8e04817f
AC
12253@table @code
12254@item remotetimeout @var{args}
12255@kindex remotetimeout
12256@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12257This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12258seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12259@end table
12260
8e04817f
AC
12261@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12262When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12263information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12264load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12265@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 12266
474c8240 12267@smallexample
8e04817f 12268sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 12269@end smallexample
104c1213 12270
8e04817f 12271You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 12272
474c8240 12273@smallexample
8e04817f 12274sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 12275@end smallexample
104c1213 12276
8e04817f
AC
12277@cindex running, on Sparclet
12278Once you have set
12279your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12280run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12281(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 12282
8e04817f
AC
12283@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12284
474c8240 12285@smallexample
8e04817f 12286(gdbslet)
474c8240 12287@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12288
12289@menu
8e04817f
AC
12290* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12291* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12292* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12293* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12294@end menu
12295
8e04817f
AC
12296@node Sparclet File
12297@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 12298
8e04817f 12299The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 12300
474c8240 12301@smallexample
8e04817f 12302(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 12303@end smallexample
104c1213 12304
8e04817f
AC
12305@need 1000
12306@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12307@value{GDBN} locates
12308the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12309path.
12310If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12311files will be searched as well.
12312@value{GDBN} locates
12313the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12314path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12315If it fails
12316to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 12317
474c8240 12318@smallexample
8e04817f 12319prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12320@end smallexample
104c1213 12321
8e04817f
AC
12322When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12323the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12324@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12325
8e04817f
AC
12326@node Sparclet Connection
12327@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12328
8e04817f
AC
12329The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12330To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12331
474c8240 12332@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12333(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12334Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12335main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12336@end smallexample
104c1213 12337
8e04817f
AC
12338@need 750
12339@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12340
474c8240 12341@smallexample
8e04817f 12342Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12343@end smallexample
104c1213 12344
8e04817f
AC
12345@node Sparclet Download
12346@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12347
8e04817f
AC
12348@cindex download to Sparclet
12349Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12350you can use the @value{GDBN}
12351@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12352The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12353command.
12354Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12355address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12356offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12357of each of the file's sections.
12358For instance, if the program
12359@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12360and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12361
474c8240 12362@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12363(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12364Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12365@end smallexample
104c1213 12366
8e04817f
AC
12367If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12368to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12369to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12370
12371@node Sparclet Execution
12372@subsubsection Running and debugging
12373
12374@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12375You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12376commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12377manual for the list of commands.
12378
474c8240 12379@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12380(gdbslet) b main
12381Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12382(gdbslet) run
12383Starting program: prog
12384Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
123853 char *symarg = 0;
12386(gdbslet) step
123874 char *execarg = "hello!";
12388(gdbslet)
474c8240 12389@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12390
12391@node Sparclite
12392@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12393
12394@table @code
12395
8e04817f
AC
12396@kindex target sparclite
12397@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12398Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12399You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12400For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12401remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12402
12403@end table
12404
8e04817f
AC
12405@node ST2000
12406@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12407
8e04817f
AC
12408@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12409STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12410
8e04817f
AC
12411To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12412manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12413
474c8240 12414@smallexample
8e04817f 12415target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12416@end smallexample
104c1213 12417
8e04817f
AC
12418@noindent
12419to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12420the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12421ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12422connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12423concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12424
8e04817f
AC
12425The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12426this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12427would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12428(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12429available on your host computer.
12430@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12431@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12432
8e04817f
AC
12433@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12434These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12435environment:
104c1213 12436
8e04817f
AC
12437@table @code
12438@item st2000 @var{command}
12439@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12440@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12441@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12442Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12443manual for available commands.
104c1213 12444
8e04817f
AC
12445@item connect
12446@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12447Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12448you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12449sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12450@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12451@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12452@end table
12453
8e04817f
AC
12454@node Z8000
12455@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12456
8e04817f
AC
12457@cindex Z8000
12458@cindex simulator, Z8000
12459@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12460
8e04817f
AC
12461When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12462a Z8000 simulator.
12463
12464For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12465unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12466segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12467appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12468
8e04817f
AC
12469@table @code
12470@item target sim @var{args}
12471@kindex sim
12472@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12473Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12474options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12475@end table
12476
8e04817f
AC
12477@noindent
12478After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12479CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12480@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12481to run your program, and so on.
12482
12483As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12484(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12485additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12486
12487@table @code
12488
8e04817f
AC
12489@item cycles
12490Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12491
8e04817f
AC
12492@item insts
12493Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12494
8e04817f
AC
12495@item time
12496Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12497
8e04817f 12498@end table
104c1213 12499
8e04817f
AC
12500You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12501conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12502conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12503simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12504
8e04817f
AC
12505@node Architectures
12506@section Architectures
104c1213 12507
8e04817f
AC
12508This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12509all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12510
8e04817f
AC
12511@menu
12512* A29K::
12513* Alpha::
12514* MIPS::
12515@end menu
104c1213 12516
8e04817f
AC
12517@node A29K
12518@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12519
12520@table @code
104c1213 12521
8e04817f
AC
12522@kindex set rstack_high_address
12523@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12524@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12525@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12526On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12527@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12528extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12529stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12530memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12531this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12532the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12533address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12534hexadecimal.
104c1213 12535
8e04817f
AC
12536@kindex show rstack_high_address
12537@item show rstack_high_address
12538Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12539processors.
104c1213 12540
8e04817f 12541@end table
104c1213 12542
8e04817f
AC
12543@node Alpha
12544@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12545
8e04817f 12546See the following section.
104c1213 12547
8e04817f
AC
12548@node MIPS
12549@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12550
8e04817f
AC
12551@cindex stack on Alpha
12552@cindex stack on MIPS
12553@cindex Alpha stack
12554@cindex MIPS stack
12555Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12556sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12557find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12558
8e04817f
AC
12559@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12560To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12561@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12562you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12563commands:
104c1213 12564
8e04817f
AC
12565@table @code
12566@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12567@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12568Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12569search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12570default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12571larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12572and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12573
8e04817f
AC
12574@item show heuristic-fence-post
12575Display the current limit.
12576@end table
104c1213
JM
12577
12578@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12579These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12580for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12581
104c1213 12582
8e04817f
AC
12583@node Controlling GDB
12584@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12585
12586You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12587@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12588data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12589described here.
12590
12591@menu
12592* Prompt:: Prompt
12593* Editing:: Command editing
12594* History:: Command history
12595* Screen Size:: Screen size
12596* Numbers:: Numbers
1e698235 12597* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
8e04817f
AC
12598* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12599* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12600@end menu
12601
12602@node Prompt
12603@section Prompt
104c1213 12604
8e04817f 12605@cindex prompt
104c1213 12606
8e04817f
AC
12607@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12608called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12609can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12610instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12611the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12612which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12613
8e04817f
AC
12614@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12615prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12616or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12617
8e04817f
AC
12618@table @code
12619@kindex set prompt
12620@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12621Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12622
8e04817f
AC
12623@kindex show prompt
12624@item show prompt
12625Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12626@end table
12627
8e04817f
AC
12628@node Editing
12629@section Command editing
12630@cindex readline
12631@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12632
8e04817f
AC
12633@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12634@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12635command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12636or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12637substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12638debugging sessions.
104c1213 12639
8e04817f
AC
12640You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12641command @code{set}.
104c1213 12642
8e04817f
AC
12643@table @code
12644@kindex set editing
12645@cindex editing
12646@item set editing
12647@itemx set editing on
12648Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12649
8e04817f
AC
12650@item set editing off
12651Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12652
8e04817f
AC
12653@kindex show editing
12654@item show editing
12655Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12656@end table
12657
8e04817f
AC
12658@node History
12659@section Command history
12660
12661@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12662debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12663happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12664history facility.
104c1213
JM
12665
12666@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12667@cindex history substitution
12668@cindex history file
12669@kindex set history filename
12670@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12671@item set history filename @var{fname}
12672Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12673This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12674list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12675exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12676the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12677to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12678@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12679is not set.
104c1213 12680
8e04817f
AC
12681@cindex history save
12682@kindex set history save
12683@item set history save
12684@itemx set history save on
12685Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12686@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12687
8e04817f
AC
12688@item set history save off
12689Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12690
8e04817f
AC
12691@cindex history size
12692@kindex set history size
12693@item set history size @var{size}
12694Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12695This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12696@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12697@end table
12698
8e04817f
AC
12699@cindex history expansion
12700History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12701@ifset have-readline-appendices
12702@xref{Event Designators}.
12703@end ifset
12704
12705Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12706is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12707@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12708follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12709a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12710history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12711@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12712
12713The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12714
12715@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12716@kindex set history expansion
12717@item set history expansion on
12718@itemx set history expansion
12719Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12720
8e04817f
AC
12721@item set history expansion off
12722Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12723
8e04817f
AC
12724The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12725editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12726or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12727@ifset have-readline-appendices
12728@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12729@end ifset
104c1213 12730
8e04817f
AC
12731@c @group
12732@kindex show history
12733@item show history
12734@itemx show history filename
12735@itemx show history save
12736@itemx show history size
12737@itemx show history expansion
12738These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12739@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12740@c @end group
12741@end table
12742
12743@table @code
12744@kindex shows
12745@item show commands
12746Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12747
8e04817f
AC
12748@item show commands @var{n}
12749Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12750
12751@item show commands +
12752Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12753@end table
12754
8e04817f
AC
12755@node Screen Size
12756@section Screen size
12757@cindex size of screen
12758@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12759
8e04817f
AC
12760Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12761information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12762@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12763output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12764to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12765determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12766printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12767rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12768
12769Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12770driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12771together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12772@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12773you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12774width} commands:
12775
12776@table @code
12777@kindex set height
12778@kindex set width
12779@kindex show width
12780@kindex show height
12781@item set height @var{lpp}
12782@itemx show height
12783@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12784@itemx show width
12785These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12786a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12787commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12788
8e04817f
AC
12789If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12790output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12791file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12792
8e04817f
AC
12793Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12794from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12795@end table
12796
8e04817f
AC
12797@node Numbers
12798@section Numbers
12799@cindex number representation
12800@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12801
8e04817f
AC
12802You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12803@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12804@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12805begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12806default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12807numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12808change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12809radix} command.
104c1213 12810
8e04817f
AC
12811@table @code
12812@kindex set input-radix
12813@item set input-radix @var{base}
12814Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12815for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12816specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12817example, any of
104c1213 12818
8e04817f
AC
12819@smallexample
12820set radix 012
12821set radix 10.
12822set radix 0xa
12823@end smallexample
104c1213 12824
8e04817f
AC
12825@noindent
12826sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12827leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12828
8e04817f
AC
12829@kindex set output-radix
12830@item set output-radix @var{base}
12831Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12832for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12833specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12834
8e04817f
AC
12835@kindex show input-radix
12836@item show input-radix
12837Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12838
8e04817f
AC
12839@kindex show output-radix
12840@item show output-radix
12841Display the current default base for numeric display.
12842@end table
104c1213 12843
1e698235
DJ
12844@node ABI
12845@section Configuring the current ABI
12846
12847@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12848application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12849conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12850current ABI.
12851
98b45e30
DJ
12852@cindex OS ABI
12853@kindex set osabi
b4e9345d 12854@kindex show osabi
98b45e30
DJ
12855
12856One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
12857system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
12858@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
12859but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
12860One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
12861an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
12862not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
12863platform provides.
12864
12865@table @code
12866@item show osabi
12867Show the OS ABI currently in use.
12868
12869@item set osabi
12870With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
12871
12872@item set osabi @var{abi}
12873Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
12874@end table
12875
1e698235
DJ
12876@cindex float promotion
12877@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
12878
12879Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
12880function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
12881(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
12882according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
12883(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
12884@code{double} and then passed.
12885
12886Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
12887a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
12888as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
12889
12890@table @code
12891@item set coerce-float-to-double
12892@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
12893Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
12894to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
12895
12896@item set coerce-float-to-double off
12897Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
12898functions.
12899@end table
12900
f1212245
DJ
12901@kindex set cp-abi
12902@kindex show cp-abi
12903@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
12904objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
12905used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
12906programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
12907multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
12908program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
12909Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
12910before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
12911``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
12912use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
12913``auto''.
12914
12915@table @code
12916@item show cp-abi
12917Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
12918
12919@item set cp-abi
12920With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
12921
12922@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
12923@itemx set cp-abi auto
12924Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
12925@end table
12926
8e04817f
AC
12927@node Messages/Warnings
12928@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12929
8e04817f
AC
12930By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12931running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12932command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12933internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12934
8e04817f
AC
12935Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12936which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12937see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12938
8e04817f
AC
12939@table @code
12940@kindex set verbose
12941@item set verbose on
12942Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12943
8e04817f
AC
12944@item set verbose off
12945Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12946
8e04817f
AC
12947@kindex show verbose
12948@item show verbose
12949Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12950@end table
104c1213 12951
8e04817f
AC
12952By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12953object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12954find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12955symbol files}).
104c1213 12956
8e04817f 12957@table @code
104c1213 12958
8e04817f
AC
12959@kindex set complaints
12960@item set complaints @var{limit}
12961Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12962unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12963@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12964to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12965
8e04817f
AC
12966@kindex show complaints
12967@item show complaints
12968Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12969
8e04817f 12970@end table
104c1213 12971
8e04817f
AC
12972By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12973lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12974you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12975
474c8240 12976@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12977(@value{GDBP}) run
12978The program being debugged has been started already.
12979Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12980@end smallexample
104c1213 12981
8e04817f
AC
12982If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12983commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12984
8e04817f 12985@table @code
104c1213 12986
8e04817f
AC
12987@kindex set confirm
12988@cindex flinching
12989@cindex confirmation
12990@cindex stupid questions
12991@item set confirm off
12992Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12993
8e04817f
AC
12994@item set confirm on
12995Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12996
8e04817f
AC
12997@kindex show confirm
12998@item show confirm
12999Displays state of confirmation requests.
13000
13001@end table
104c1213 13002
8e04817f
AC
13003@node Debugging Output
13004@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 13005@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13006@kindex set debug arch
13007@item set debug arch
13008Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
13009@kindex show debug arch
13010@item show debug arch
13011Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
13012@kindex set debug event
13013@item set debug event
13014Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
13015default is off.
13016@kindex show debug event
13017@item show debug event
13018Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
13019info.
13020@kindex set debug expression
13021@item set debug expression
13022Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
13023default is off.
13024@kindex show debug expression
13025@item show debug expression
13026Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
13027debugging info.
7453dc06
AC
13028@kindex set debug frame
13029@item set debug frame
13030Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
13031default is off.
13032@kindex show debug frame
13033@item show debug frame
13034Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
13035info.
8e04817f
AC
13036@kindex set debug overload
13037@item set debug overload
13038Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
13039info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
13040is off.
13041@kindex show debug overload
13042@item show debug overload
13043Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
13044debugging info.
13045@kindex set debug remote
13046@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
13047@cindex serial connections, debugging
13048@item set debug remote
13049Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
13050the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
13051@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
13052@kindex show debug remote
13053@item show debug remote
13054Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13055@kindex set debug serial
13056@item set debug serial
13057Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13058default is off.
13059@kindex show debug serial
13060@item show debug serial
13061Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13062info.
13063@kindex set debug target
13064@item set debug target
13065Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13066includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
13067default is off.
13068@kindex show debug target
13069@item show debug target
13070Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13071info.
13072@kindex set debug varobj
13073@item set debug varobj
13074Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13075info. The default is off.
13076@kindex show debug varobj
13077@item show debug varobj
13078Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13079debugging info.
13080@end table
104c1213 13081
8e04817f
AC
13082@node Sequences
13083@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 13084
8e04817f
AC
13085Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
13086command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13087commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13088files.
104c1213 13089
8e04817f
AC
13090@menu
13091* Define:: User-defined commands
13092* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13093* Command Files:: Command files
13094* Output:: Commands for controlled output
13095@end menu
104c1213 13096
8e04817f
AC
13097@node Define
13098@section User-defined commands
104c1213 13099
8e04817f
AC
13100@cindex user-defined command
13101A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13102which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13103@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13104separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13105via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 13106
8e04817f
AC
13107@smallexample
13108define adder
13109 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13110@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
13111
13112@noindent
8e04817f 13113To execute the command use:
104c1213 13114
8e04817f
AC
13115@smallexample
13116adder 1 2 3
13117@end smallexample
104c1213 13118
8e04817f
AC
13119@noindent
13120This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
13121its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
13122reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13123functions calls.
104c1213
JM
13124
13125@table @code
104c1213 13126
8e04817f
AC
13127@kindex define
13128@item define @var{commandname}
13129Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13130by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 13131
8e04817f
AC
13132The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13133which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13134commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 13135
8e04817f
AC
13136@kindex if
13137@kindex else
13138@item if
13139Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13140It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13141only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13142There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13143by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13144was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 13145
8e04817f
AC
13146@kindex while
13147@item while
13148The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13149which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13150execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13151The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13152evaluates to true.
104c1213 13153
8e04817f
AC
13154@kindex document
13155@item document @var{commandname}
13156Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
13157accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13158defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13159reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13160After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
13161@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 13162
8e04817f
AC
13163You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13164documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13165does not change the documentation.
104c1213 13166
8e04817f
AC
13167@kindex help user-defined
13168@item help user-defined
13169List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13170(if any) for each.
104c1213 13171
8e04817f
AC
13172@kindex show user
13173@item show user
13174@itemx show user @var{commandname}
13175Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13176not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
13177definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 13178
20f01a46
DH
13179@kindex show max-user-call-depth
13180@kindex set max-user-call-depth
13181@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
13182@itemx set max-user-call-depth
13183The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
13184levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
13185infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 13186
104c1213
JM
13187@end table
13188
8e04817f
AC
13189When user-defined commands are executed, the
13190commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13191stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 13192
8e04817f
AC
13193If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
13194without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13195commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
13196messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 13197
8e04817f
AC
13198@node Hooks
13199@section User-defined command hooks
13200@cindex command hooks
13201@cindex hooks, for commands
13202@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 13203
8e04817f
AC
13204@kindex hook
13205@kindex hook-
13206You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
13207command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13208command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13209before that command.
104c1213 13210
8e04817f
AC
13211@cindex hooks, post-command
13212@kindex hookpost
13213@kindex hookpost-
13214A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13215Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13216@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13217that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13218pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 13219
8e04817f
AC
13220It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13221occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 13222
8e04817f
AC
13223@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13224@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 13225
8e04817f
AC
13226@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
13227In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13228(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13229execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13230displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 13231
8e04817f
AC
13232For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13233single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13234you could define:
104c1213 13235
474c8240 13236@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13237define hook-stop
13238handle SIGALRM nopass
13239end
104c1213 13240
8e04817f
AC
13241define hook-run
13242handle SIGALRM pass
13243end
104c1213 13244
8e04817f
AC
13245define hook-continue
13246handle SIGLARM pass
13247end
474c8240 13248@end smallexample
104c1213 13249
8e04817f
AC
13250As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13251command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13252you could define:
104c1213 13253
474c8240 13254@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13255define hook-echo
13256echo <<<---
13257end
104c1213 13258
8e04817f
AC
13259define hookpost-echo
13260echo --->>>\n
13261end
104c1213 13262
8e04817f
AC
13263(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13264<<<---Hello World--->>>
13265(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 13266
474c8240 13267@end smallexample
104c1213 13268
8e04817f
AC
13269You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13270not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13271name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13272@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13273@c or not?
13274If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13275@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13276(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 13277
8e04817f
AC
13278If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13279get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 13280
8e04817f
AC
13281@node Command Files
13282@section Command files
c906108c 13283
8e04817f
AC
13284@cindex command files
13285A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13286commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13287An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13288the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 13289
8e04817f
AC
13290@cindex init file
13291@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13292@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13293When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13294@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13295port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13296limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13297During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 13298
8e04817f
AC
13299@enumerate
13300@item
13301Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13302DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13303@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 13304
8e04817f
AC
13305@item
13306Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 13307
8e04817f
AC
13308@item
13309Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 13310
8e04817f
AC
13311@item
13312Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13313@end enumerate
c906108c 13314
8e04817f
AC
13315The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13316complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13317and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13318option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13319
8e04817f
AC
13320@cindex init file name
13321On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13322different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13323form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13324different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13325environments with special init file names:
c906108c 13326
8e04817f
AC
13327@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13328@itemize @bullet
13329@item
13330VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13331
8e04817f
AC
13332@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13333@item
13334OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13335
8e04817f
AC
13336@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13337@item
13338ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13339@end itemize
c906108c 13340
8e04817f
AC
13341You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13342@code{source} command:
c906108c 13343
8e04817f
AC
13344@table @code
13345@kindex source
13346@item source @var{filename}
13347Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
13348@end table
13349
8e04817f 13350The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
13351printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13352execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 13353
8e04817f
AC
13354Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13355without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13356normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13357when called from command files.
c906108c 13358
8e04817f
AC
13359@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13360mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13361standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13362not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13363the next command.
c906108c 13364
474c8240 13365@smallexample
8e04817f 13366gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 13367@end smallexample
c906108c 13368
8e04817f
AC
13369(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13370will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13371would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13372
8e04817f
AC
13373@node Output
13374@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13375
8e04817f
AC
13376During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13377@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13378explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13379describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13380want.
c906108c
SS
13381
13382@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13383@kindex echo
13384@item echo @var{text}
13385@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13386@c because it is not in ANSI.
13387Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13388@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13389newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13390In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13391by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13392string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13393trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13394To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13395@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13396
8e04817f
AC
13397A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13398the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13399
474c8240 13400@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13401echo This is some text\n\
13402which is continued\n\
13403onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13404@end smallexample
c906108c 13405
8e04817f 13406produces the same output as
c906108c 13407
474c8240 13408@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13409echo This is some text\n
13410echo which is continued\n
13411echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13412@end smallexample
c906108c 13413
8e04817f
AC
13414@kindex output
13415@item output @var{expression}
13416Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13417newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13418value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13419on expressions.
c906108c 13420
8e04817f
AC
13421@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13422Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13423the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13424formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13425
8e04817f
AC
13426@kindex printf
13427@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13428Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13429@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13430either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13431@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13432subroutine
13433@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13434@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13435@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13436@c supported.
c906108c 13437
474c8240 13438@smallexample
8e04817f 13439printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13440@end smallexample
c906108c 13441
8e04817f 13442For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13443
8e04817f
AC
13444@smallexample
13445printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13446@end smallexample
c906108c 13447
8e04817f
AC
13448The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13449string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13450letter.
c906108c
SS
13451@end table
13452
21c294e6
AC
13453@node Interpreters
13454@chapter Command Interpreters
13455@cindex command interpreters
13456
13457@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
13458infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
13459between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
13460
13461@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
13462interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
13463and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
13464describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
13465
13466By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
13467However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
13468interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
13469startup options. Defined interpreters include:
13470
13471@table @code
13472@item console
13473@cindex console interpreter
13474The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
13475used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
13476@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
13477
13478@item mi
13479@cindex mi interpreter
13480The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
13481by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
13482or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
13483Interface}.
13484
13485@item mi2
13486@cindex mi2 interpreter
13487The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
13488
13489@item mi1
13490@cindex mi1 interpreter
13491The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
13492
13493@end table
13494
13495@cindex invoke another interpreter
13496The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
13497switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
13498precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
13499enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
13500@value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
13501the IDE inoperable!
13502
13503@kindex interpreter-exec
13504Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
13505commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
13506command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
13507@code{interpreter-exec} command:
13508
13509@smallexample
13510interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
13511@end smallexample
13512
13513@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
13514@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
13515
8e04817f
AC
13516@node TUI
13517@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13518@cindex TUI
c906108c 13519
8e04817f
AC
13520@menu
13521* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13522* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13523* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13524* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13525* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13526@end menu
c906108c 13527
8e04817f
AC
13528The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13529is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13530to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13531and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13532The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13533with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13534
8e04817f
AC
13535@node TUI Overview
13536@section TUI overview
c906108c 13537
8e04817f
AC
13538The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13539@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13540
8e04817f
AC
13541@itemize @bullet
13542@item
13543A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13544windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13545
8e04817f
AC
13546@item
13547A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13548the TUI.
13549@end itemize
c906108c 13550
8e04817f
AC
13551In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13552on the terminal:
c906108c 13553
8e04817f
AC
13554@table @emph
13555@item command
13556This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13557prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13558managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13559window is always visible.
c906108c 13560
8e04817f
AC
13561@item source
13562The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13563line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13564
8e04817f
AC
13565@item assembly
13566The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13567
8e04817f
AC
13568@item register
13569This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13570a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13571changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13572
c906108c
SS
13573@end table
13574
269c21fe
SC
13575The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13576by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13577Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13578indicates the breakpoint type:
13579
13580@table @code
13581@item B
13582Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13583
13584@item b
13585Breakpoint which was never hit.
13586
13587@item H
13588Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13589
13590@item h
13591Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13592
13593@end table
13594
13595The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13596
13597@table @code
13598@item +
13599Breakpoint is enabled.
13600
13601@item -
13602Breakpoint is disabled.
13603
13604@end table
13605
8e04817f
AC
13606The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13607and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13608changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13609These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13610layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13611The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13612
8e04817f
AC
13613@itemize @bullet
13614@item
13615source
2df3850c 13616
8e04817f
AC
13617@item
13618assembly
13619
13620@item
13621source and assembly
13622
13623@item
13624source and registers
c906108c 13625
8e04817f
AC
13626@item
13627assembly and registers
2df3850c 13628
8e04817f 13629@end itemize
c906108c 13630
b7bb15bc
SC
13631On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13632concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13633updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13634are displayed:
13635
13636@table @emph
13637@item target
13638Indicates the current gdb target
13639(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13640
13641@item process
13642Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13643When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13644
13645@item function
13646Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13647The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13648When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13649the string @code{??} is displayed.
13650
13651@item line
13652Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13653When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13654
13655@item pc
13656Indicates the current program counter address.
13657
13658@end table
13659
8e04817f
AC
13660@node TUI Keys
13661@section TUI Key Bindings
13662@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13663
8e04817f
AC
13664The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13665(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13666They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
13667directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13668a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13669@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 13670are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13671
8e04817f
AC
13672@table @kbd
13673@kindex C-x C-a
13674@item C-x C-a
13675@kindex C-x a
13676@itemx C-x a
13677@kindex C-x A
13678@itemx C-x A
13679Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13680the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13681its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13682mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13683The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13684
8e04817f
AC
13685@kindex C-x 1
13686@item C-x 1
13687Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13688either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13689is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13690
8e04817f 13691Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13692
8e04817f
AC
13693@kindex C-x 2
13694@item C-x 2
13695Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13696layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13697When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13698previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13699
8e04817f 13700Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13701
7cf36c78
SC
13702@kindex C-x s
13703@item C-x s
13704Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13705(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13706
c906108c
SS
13707@end table
13708
8e04817f 13709The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13710
8e04817f
AC
13711@table @key
13712@kindex PgUp
13713@item PgUp
13714Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13715
8e04817f
AC
13716@kindex PgDn
13717@item PgDn
13718Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13719
8e04817f
AC
13720@kindex Up
13721@item Up
13722Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13723
8e04817f
AC
13724@kindex Down
13725@item Down
13726Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13727
8e04817f
AC
13728@kindex Left
13729@item Left
13730Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13731
8e04817f
AC
13732@kindex Right
13733@item Right
13734Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13735
8e04817f
AC
13736@kindex C-L
13737@item C-L
13738Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13739
8e04817f 13740@end table
c906108c 13741
8e04817f
AC
13742In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13743for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13744necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13745@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13746
7cf36c78
SC
13747@node TUI Single Key Mode
13748@section TUI Single Key Mode
13749@cindex TUI single key mode
13750
13751The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13752key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13753some gdb commands.
13754
13755@table @kbd
13756@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13757@item c
13758continue
13759
13760@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13761@item d
13762down
13763
13764@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13765@item f
13766finish
13767
13768@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13769@item n
13770next
13771
13772@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13773@item q
13774exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13775
13776@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13777@item r
13778run
13779
13780@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13781@item s
13782step
13783
13784@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13785@item u
13786up
13787
13788@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13789@item v
13790info locals
13791
13792@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13793@item w
13794where
13795
13796@end table
13797
13798Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13799The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13800it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13801with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13802@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13803this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13804
13805
8e04817f
AC
13806@node TUI Commands
13807@section TUI specific commands
13808@cindex TUI commands
13809
13810The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13811These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13812the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13813is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13814in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13815
13816@table @code
3d757584
SC
13817@item info win
13818@kindex info win
13819List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13820
8e04817f
AC
13821@item layout next
13822@kindex layout next
13823Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13824
8e04817f
AC
13825@item layout prev
13826@kindex layout prev
13827Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13828
8e04817f
AC
13829@item layout src
13830@kindex layout src
13831Display the source window only.
c906108c 13832
8e04817f
AC
13833@item layout asm
13834@kindex layout asm
13835Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13836
8e04817f
AC
13837@item layout split
13838@kindex layout split
13839Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13840
8e04817f
AC
13841@item layout regs
13842@kindex layout regs
13843Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13844
13845@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13846@kindex focus
13847Set the focus to the named window.
13848This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13849can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13850
8e04817f
AC
13851@item refresh
13852@kindex refresh
13853Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13854
8e04817f
AC
13855@item update
13856@kindex update
13857Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13858
8e04817f
AC
13859@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13860@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13861@kindex winheight
13862Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13863lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13864decrease it.
2df3850c 13865
c906108c
SS
13866@end table
13867
8e04817f
AC
13868@node TUI Configuration
13869@section TUI configuration variables
13870@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13871
8e04817f
AC
13872The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13873appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13874
8e04817f
AC
13875@table @code
13876@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13877@kindex set tui border-kind
13878Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13879The possible values are the following:
13880@table @code
13881@item space
13882Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13883
8e04817f
AC
13884@item ascii
13885Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13886
8e04817f
AC
13887@item acs
13888Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13889drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13890
8e04817f 13891@end table
c78b4128 13892
8e04817f
AC
13893@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13894@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13895Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13896The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13897@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13898
8e04817f
AC
13899@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13900@kindex set tui border-mode
13901Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13902The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13903@table @code
13904@item normal
13905Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13906
8e04817f
AC
13907@item standout
13908Use standout mode.
c906108c 13909
8e04817f
AC
13910@item reverse
13911Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13912
8e04817f
AC
13913@item half
13914Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13915
8e04817f
AC
13916@item half-standout
13917Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13918
8e04817f
AC
13919@item bold
13920Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13921
8e04817f
AC
13922@item bold-standout
13923Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13924
8e04817f 13925@end table
c78b4128 13926
8e04817f 13927@end table
c78b4128 13928
8e04817f
AC
13929@node Emacs
13930@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13931
8e04817f
AC
13932@cindex Emacs
13933@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13934A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13935edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13936@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13937
8e04817f
AC
13938To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13939executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13940@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13941created Emacs buffer.
13942@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13943
8e04817f
AC
13944Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13945things:
c906108c 13946
8e04817f
AC
13947@itemize @bullet
13948@item
13949All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13950@end itemize
c906108c 13951
8e04817f
AC
13952This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13953and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13954
8e04817f
AC
13955This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13956commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13957in this way.
bf0184be 13958
8e04817f
AC
13959All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13960with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13961way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13962stop.
bf0184be 13963
8e04817f 13964@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13965@item
8e04817f
AC
13966@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13967@end itemize
bf0184be 13968
8e04817f
AC
13969Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13970source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13971left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13972source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13973and the source.
bf0184be 13974
8e04817f
AC
13975Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13976usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13977
8e04817f
AC
13978@quotation
13979@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13980current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13981the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13982appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13983environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13984session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13985back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13986avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13987your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13988@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13989
8e04817f
AC
13990A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13991switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13992@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13993@end quotation
13994
13995By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13996you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13997several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13998Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13999
474c8240 14000@smallexample
8e04817f 14001(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 14002@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14003
14004@noindent
14005(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
14006in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
14007``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
14008
14009In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
14010addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 14011
8e04817f
AC
14012@table @kbd
14013@item C-h m
14014Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 14015
8e04817f
AC
14016@item M-s
14017Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
14018update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 14019
8e04817f
AC
14020@item M-n
14021Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
14022calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
14023to show the current file and location.
c906108c 14024
8e04817f
AC
14025@item M-i
14026Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
14027display window accordingly.
c906108c 14028
8e04817f
AC
14029@item M-x gdb-nexti
14030Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
14031display window accordingly.
c906108c 14032
8e04817f
AC
14033@item C-c C-f
14034Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
14035@code{finish} command.
c906108c 14036
8e04817f
AC
14037@item M-c
14038Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
14039command.
b433d00b 14040
8e04817f 14041@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 14042
8e04817f
AC
14043@item M-u
14044Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
14045(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
14046like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 14047
8e04817f 14048@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 14049
8e04817f
AC
14050@item M-d
14051Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
14052@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 14053
8e04817f 14054@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 14055
8e04817f
AC
14056@item C-x &
14057Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
14058of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
14059around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
14060then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
14061argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 14062
8e04817f
AC
14063You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
14064@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
14065otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
14066inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
14067wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
14068list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
14069formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
14070is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
14071@end table
c906108c 14072
8e04817f
AC
14073In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
14074tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 14075
8e04817f
AC
14076If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
14077it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
14078request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
14079the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
14080frame.
c906108c 14081
8e04817f
AC
14082The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
14083which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
14084the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
14085communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
14086delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
14087to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 14088
8e04817f
AC
14089@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
14090@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
14091@ignore
14092@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
14093@kindex Epoch
14094@kindex inspect
c906108c 14095
8e04817f
AC
14096Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
14097called the @code{epoch}
14098environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14099@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14100each value is printed in its own window.
14101@end ignore
c906108c 14102
922fbb7b
AC
14103
14104@node GDB/MI
14105@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
14106
14107@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
14108
14109@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
14110@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to @value{GDBN}. It is
14111specifically intended to support the development of systems which use
14112the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
14113
14114This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
14115in the form of a reference manual.
14116
14117Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
14118features described below are incomplete and subject to change.
14119
14120@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
14121
14122@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
14123This chapter uses the following notation:
14124
14125@itemize @bullet
14126@item
14127@code{|} separates two alternatives.
14128
14129@item
14130@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
14131it may or may not be given.
14132
14133@item
14134@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14135may repeat zero or more times.
14136
14137@item
14138@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14139may repeat one or more times.
14140
14141@item
14142@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
14143@end itemize
14144
14145@ignore
14146@heading Dependencies
14147@end ignore
14148
14149@heading Acknowledgments
14150
14151In alphabetic order: Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, Stan Shebs and
14152Elena Zannoni.
14153
14154@menu
14155* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
14156* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
14157* GDB/MI Output Records::
14158* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
14159* GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands::
14160* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
14161* GDB/MI Program Control::
14162* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
14163@ignore
14164* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
14165* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
14166* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
14167@end ignore
14168* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
14169* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
14170* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
14171* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
14172* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
14173* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
14174@end menu
14175
14176@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14177@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
14178@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
14179
14180@menu
14181* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
14182* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
14183* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
14184@end menu
14185
14186@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
14187@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
14188
14189@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
14190@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
14191@table @code
14192@item @var{command} @expansion{}
14193@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
14194
14195@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
14196@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
14197@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14198
14199@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
14200@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
14201@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
14202
14203@item @var{token} @expansion{}
14204"any sequence of digits"
14205
14206@item @var{option} @expansion{}
14207@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
14208
14209@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
14210@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
14211
14212@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
14213@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
14214
14215@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
14216@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
14217"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
14218
14219@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
14220@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
14221
14222@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14223@code{CR | CR-LF}
14224@end table
14225
14226@noindent
14227Notes:
14228
14229@itemize @bullet
14230@item
14231The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
14232output is described below.
14233
14234@item
14235The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
14236finishes.
14237
14238@item
14239Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
14240list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
14241followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
14242parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
14243@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
14244@end itemize
14245
14246Pragmatics:
14247
14248@itemize @bullet
14249@item
14250We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
14251
14252@item
14253We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
14254@end itemize
14255
14256@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
14257@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
14258
14259@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
14260@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
14261The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
14262followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
14263is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
14264terminated by @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.
14265
14266If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
14267corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
14268@var{token}.
14269
14270@table @code
14271@item @var{output} @expansion{}
14272@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
14273
14274@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
14275@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14276
14277@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
14278@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
14279
14280@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
14281@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
14282
14283@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
14284@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
14285
14286@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
14287@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
14288
14289@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
14290@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
14291
14292@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
14293@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14294
14295@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
14296@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
14297
14298@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
14299@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
14300depending on the needs---this is still in development).
14301
14302@item @var{result} @expansion{}
14303@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
14304
14305@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
14306@code{ @var{string} }
14307
14308@item @var{value} @expansion{}
14309@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
14310
14311@item @var{const} @expansion{}
14312@code{@var{c-string}}
14313
14314@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
14315@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
14316
14317@item @var{list} @expansion{}
14318@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
14319@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
14320
14321@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
14322@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
14323
14324@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
14325@code{"~" @var{c-string}}
14326
14327@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
14328@code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
14329
14330@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
14331@code{"&" @var{c-string}}
14332
14333@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14334@code{CR | CR-LF}
14335
14336@item @var{token} @expansion{}
14337@emph{any sequence of digits}.
14338@end table
14339
14340@noindent
14341Notes:
14342
14343@itemize @bullet
14344@item
14345All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
14346
14347@item
14348The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
14349command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
14350@var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
14351original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
14352
14353@item
14354@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14355@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
14356progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
14357prefixed by @samp{+}.
14358
14359@item
14360@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14361@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
14362(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
14363@samp{*}.
14364
14365@item
14366@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14367@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
14368client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
14369output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
14370
14371@item
14372@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14373@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
14374console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
14375output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
14376
14377@item
14378@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14379@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
14380All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
14381
14382@item
14383@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14384@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
14385instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
14386the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
14387
14388@item
14389@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14390New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
14391@var{values}.
14392
14393
14394@end itemize
14395
14396@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
14397details about the various output records.
14398
14399@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
14400@subsection Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
14401@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
14402
14403This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
14404the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
14405following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
14406the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
14407
14408@subsubheading Target Stop
14409@c Ummm... There is no "-stop" command. This assumes async, no?
14410Here's an example of stopping the inferior process:
14411
14412@smallexample
14413-> -stop
14414<- (@value{GDBP})
14415@end smallexample
14416
14417@noindent
14418and later:
14419
14420@smallexample
14421<- *stop,reason="stop",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14422<- (@value{GDBP})
14423@end smallexample
14424
14425@subsubheading Simple CLI Command
14426
14427Here's an example of a simple CLI command being passed through
14428@sc{gdb/mi} and on to the CLI.
14429
14430@smallexample
14431-> print 1+2
14432<- &"print 1+2\n"
14433<- ~"$1 = 3\n"
14434<- ^done
14435<- (@value{GDBP})
14436@end smallexample
14437
14438@subsubheading Command With Side Effects
14439
14440@smallexample
14441-> -symbol-file xyz.exe
14442<- *breakpoint,nr="3",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14443<- (@value{GDBP})
14444@end smallexample
14445
14446@subsubheading A Bad Command
14447
14448Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
14449
14450@smallexample
14451-> -rubbish
14452<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
14453<- (@value{GDBP})
14454@end smallexample
14455
14456@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14457@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
14458@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
14459
14460@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
14461@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
14462To help users familiar with @value{GDBN}'s existing CLI interface, @sc{gdb/mi}
14463accepts existing CLI commands. As specified by the syntax, such
14464commands can be directly entered into the @sc{gdb/mi} interface and @value{GDBN} will
14465respond.
14466
14467This mechanism is provided as an aid to developers of @sc{gdb/mi}
14468clients and not as a reliable interface into the CLI. Since the command
14469is being interpreteted in an environment that assumes @sc{gdb/mi}
14470behaviour, the exact output of such commands is likely to end up being
14471an un-supported hybrid of @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI output.
14472
14473@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14474@node GDB/MI Output Records
14475@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
14476
14477@menu
14478* GDB/MI Result Records::
14479* GDB/MI Stream Records::
14480* GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
14481@end menu
14482
14483@node GDB/MI Result Records
14484@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
14485
14486@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14487@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
14488In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
14489@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
14490
14491@table @code
14492@findex ^done
14493@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
14494The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
14495values.
14496
14497@item "^running"
14498@findex ^running
14499@c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
14500The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
14501running.
14502
14503@item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
14504@findex ^error
14505The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
14506error message.
14507@end table
14508
14509@node GDB/MI Stream Records
14510@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
14511
14512@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
14513@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14514@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
14515target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
14516funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
14517
14518Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
14519identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
14520Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
14521@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
14522line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
14523
14524@table @code
14525@item "~" @var{string-output}
14526The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
14527CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
14528
14529@item "@@" @var{string-output}
14530The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
14531target.
14532
14533@item "&" @var{string-output}
14534The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
14535internals.
14536@end table
14537
14538@node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
14539@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
14540
14541@cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14542@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
14543@dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
14544additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
14545consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
14546target activity (e.g., target stopped).
14547
14548The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
14549
14550@table @code
14551@item "*" "stop"
14552@end table
14553
14554
14555@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14556@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
14557@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
14558
14559The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
14560commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
14561
14562Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
14563readability. They don't appear in the real output.
14564Also note that the commands with a non-available example (N.A.@:) are
14565not yet implemented.
14566
14567@subheading Motivation
14568
14569The motivation for this collection of commands.
14570
14571@subheading Introduction
14572
14573A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
14574
14575@subheading Commands
14576
14577For each command in the block, the following is described:
14578
14579@subsubheading Synopsis
14580
14581@smallexample
14582 -command @var{args}@dots{}
14583@end smallexample
14584
14585@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14586
14587The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14588
14589@subsubheading Result
14590
14591@subsubheading Out-of-band
14592
14593@subsubheading Notes
14594
14595@subsubheading Example
14596
14597
14598@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14599@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands
14600@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint table commands
14601
14602@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
14603@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
14604This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
14605breakpoints.
14606
14607@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
14608@findex -break-after
14609
14610@subsubheading Synopsis
14611
14612@smallexample
14613 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
14614@end smallexample
14615
14616The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
14617hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
14618the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
14619@samp{-break-list} command below.
14620
14621@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14622
14623The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
14624
14625@subsubheading Example
14626
14627@smallexample
14628(@value{GDBP})
14629-break-insert main
14630^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",line="5"@}
14631(@value{GDBP})
14632-break-after 1 3
14633~
14634^done
14635(@value{GDBP})
14636-break-list
14637^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14638hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14639@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14640@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14641@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14642@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14643@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14644body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14645addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0",
14646ignore="3"@}]@}
14647(@value{GDBP})
14648@end smallexample
14649
14650@ignore
14651@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
14652@findex -break-catch
14653
14654@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
14655@findex -break-commands
14656@end ignore
14657
14658
14659@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
14660@findex -break-condition
14661
14662@subsubheading Synopsis
14663
14664@smallexample
14665 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
14666@end smallexample
14667
14668Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
14669@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
14670@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
14671command below).
14672
14673@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14674
14675The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
14676
14677@subsubheading Example
14678
14679@smallexample
14680(@value{GDBP})
14681-break-condition 1 1
14682^done
14683(@value{GDBP})
14684-break-list
14685^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14686hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14687@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14688@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14689@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14690@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14691@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14692body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14693addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",cond="1",
14694times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
14695(@value{GDBP})
14696@end smallexample
14697
14698@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
14699@findex -break-delete
14700
14701@subsubheading Synopsis
14702
14703@smallexample
14704 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14705@end smallexample
14706
14707Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
14708list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
14709
14710@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
14711
14712The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
14713
14714@subsubheading Example
14715
14716@smallexample
14717(@value{GDBP})
14718-break-delete 1
14719^done
14720(@value{GDBP})
14721-break-list
14722^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
14723hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14724@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14725@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14726@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14727@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14728@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14729body=[]@}
14730(@value{GDBP})
14731@end smallexample
14732
14733@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
14734@findex -break-disable
14735
14736@subsubheading Synopsis
14737
14738@smallexample
14739 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14740@end smallexample
14741
14742Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
14743break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
14744
14745@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14746
14747The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
14748
14749@subsubheading Example
14750
14751@smallexample
14752(@value{GDBP})
14753-break-disable 2
14754^done
14755(@value{GDBP})
14756-break-list
14757^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14758hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14759@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14760@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14761@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14762@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14763@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14764body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
14765addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
14766(@value{GDBP})
14767@end smallexample
14768
14769@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
14770@findex -break-enable
14771
14772@subsubheading Synopsis
14773
14774@smallexample
14775 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14776@end smallexample
14777
14778Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
14779
14780@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14781
14782The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
14783
14784@subsubheading Example
14785
14786@smallexample
14787(@value{GDBP})
14788-break-enable 2
14789^done
14790(@value{GDBP})
14791-break-list
14792^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14793hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14794@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14795@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14796@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14797@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14798@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14799body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14800addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
14801(@value{GDBP})
14802@end smallexample
14803
14804@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
14805@findex -break-info
14806
14807@subsubheading Synopsis
14808
14809@smallexample
14810 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
14811@end smallexample
14812
14813@c REDUNDANT???
14814Get information about a single breakpoint.
14815
14816@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
14817
14818The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
14819
14820@subsubheading Example
14821N.A.
14822
14823@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
14824@findex -break-insert
14825
14826@subsubheading Synopsis
14827
14828@smallexample
14829 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
14830 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
14831 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
14832@end smallexample
14833
14834@noindent
14835If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
14836
14837@itemize @bullet
14838@item function
14839@c @item +offset
14840@c @item -offset
14841@c @item linenum
14842@item filename:linenum
14843@item filename:function
14844@item *address
14845@end itemize
14846
14847The possible optional parameters of this command are:
14848
14849@table @samp
14850@item -t
14851Insert a tempoary breakpoint.
14852@item -h
14853Insert a hardware breakpoint.
14854@item -c @var{condition}
14855Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
14856@item -i @var{ignore-count}
14857Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
14858@item -r
14859Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
14860given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
14861expresson.
14862@end table
14863
14864@subsubheading Result
14865
14866The result is in the form:
14867
14868@smallexample
14869 ^done,bkptno="@var{number}",func="@var{funcname}",
14870 file="@var{filename}",line="@var{lineno}"
14871@end smallexample
14872
14873@noindent
14874where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, @var{funcname}
14875is the name of the function where the breakpoint was inserted,
14876@var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains this
14877function, and @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file.
14878
14879Note: this format is open to change.
14880@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
14881
14882@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14883
14884The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
14885@samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
14886
14887@subsubheading Example
14888
14889@smallexample
14890(@value{GDBP})
14891-break-insert main
14892^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
14893(@value{GDBP})
14894-break-insert -t foo
14895^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
14896(@value{GDBP})
14897-break-list
14898^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
14899hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14900@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14901@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14902@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14903@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14904@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14905body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14906addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",line="4",times="0"@},
14907bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
14908addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
14909(@value{GDBP})
14910-break-insert -r foo.*
14911~int foo(int, int);
14912^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
14913(@value{GDBP})
14914@end smallexample
14915
14916@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
14917@findex -break-list
14918
14919@subsubheading Synopsis
14920
14921@smallexample
14922 -break-list
14923@end smallexample
14924
14925Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
14926
14927@table @samp
14928@item Number
14929number of the breakpoint
14930@item Type
14931type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
14932@item Disposition
14933should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
14934or @samp{nokeep}
14935@item Enabled
14936is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
14937@item Address
14938memory location at which the breakpoint is set
14939@item What
14940logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
14941name, line number
14942@item Times
14943number of times the breakpoint has been hit
14944@end table
14945
14946If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
14947@code{body} field is an empty list.
14948
14949@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14950
14951The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
14952
14953@subsubheading Example
14954
14955@smallexample
14956(@value{GDBP})
14957-break-list
14958^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
14959hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14960@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14961@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14962@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14963@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14964@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14965body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14966addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
14967bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14968addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",line="13",times="0"@}]@}
14969(@value{GDBP})
14970@end smallexample
14971
14972Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
14973
14974@smallexample
14975(@value{GDBP})
14976-break-list
14977^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
14978hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14979@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14980@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14981@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14982@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14983@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14984body=[]@}
14985(@value{GDBP})
14986@end smallexample
14987
14988@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
14989@findex -break-watch
14990
14991@subsubheading Synopsis
14992
14993@smallexample
14994 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
14995@end smallexample
14996
14997Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
14998@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
14999read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
15000option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
15001trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
15002either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
15003i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
15004@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
15005
15006Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
15007breakpoints inserted.
15008
15009@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15010
15011The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
15012@samp{rwatch}.
15013
15014@subsubheading Example
15015
15016Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
15017
15018@smallexample
15019(@value{GDBP})
15020-break-watch x
15021^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
15022(@value{GDBP})
15023-exec-continue
15024^running
15025^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
15026value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
15027frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="5"@}
15028(@value{GDBP})
15029@end smallexample
15030
15031Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
15032the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
15033for the watchpoint going out of scope.
15034
15035@smallexample
15036(@value{GDBP})
15037-break-watch C
15038^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
15039(@value{GDBP})
15040-exec-continue
15041^running
15042^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
15043wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15044frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15045file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15046(@value{GDBP})
15047-exec-continue
15048^running
15049^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
15050frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15051value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15052file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15053(@value{GDBP})
15054@end smallexample
15055
15056Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
15057execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
15058deleted.
15059
15060@smallexample
15061(@value{GDBP})
15062-break-watch C
15063^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
15064(@value{GDBP})
15065-break-list
15066^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15067hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15068@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15069@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15070@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15071@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15072@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15073body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15074addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15075file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15076bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15077enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
15078(@value{GDBP})
15079-exec-continue
15080^running
15081^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
15082value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15083frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15084file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15085(@value{GDBP})
15086-break-list
15087^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15088hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15089@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15090@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15091@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15092@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15093@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15094body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15095addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15096file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15097bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15098enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
15099(@value{GDBP})
15100-exec-continue
15101^running
15102^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
15103frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15104value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15105file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15106(@value{GDBP})
15107-break-list
15108^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15109hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15110@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15111@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15112@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15113@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15114@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15115body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15116addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15117file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}]@}
15118(@value{GDBP})
15119@end smallexample
15120
15121@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15122@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
15123@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
15124
15125@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
15126@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
15127This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
15128examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
15129
15130@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
15131@c @subheading -data-assign
15132@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
15133@c @subsubheading GDB command
15134@c set variable
15135@c @subsubheading Example
15136@c N.A.
15137
15138@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
15139@findex -data-disassemble
15140
15141@subsubheading Synopsis
15142
15143@smallexample
15144 -data-disassemble
15145 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
15146 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
15147 -- @var{mode}
15148@end smallexample
15149
15150@noindent
15151Where:
15152
15153@table @samp
15154@item @var{start-addr}
15155is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
15156@item @var{end-addr}
15157is the end address
15158@item @var{filename}
15159is the name of the file to disassemble
15160@item @var{linenum}
15161is the line number to disassemble around
15162@item @var{lines}
15163is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
15164the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
15165specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
15166@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
15167@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
15168displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
15169@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
15170are displayed.
15171@item @var{mode}
15172is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
15173disassembly).
15174@end table
15175
15176@subsubheading Result
15177
15178The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
15179
15180@itemize @bullet
15181@item Address
15182@item Func-name
15183@item Offset
15184@item Instruction
15185@end itemize
15186
15187Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
15188directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
15189
15190@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15191
15192There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
15193
15194@subsubheading Example
15195
15196Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
15197
15198@smallexample
15199(@value{GDBP})
15200-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
15201^done,
15202asm_insns=[
15203@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15204inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15205@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15206inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15207@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
15208inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
15209@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
15210inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15211@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
15212inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
15213(@value{GDBP})
15214@end smallexample
15215
15216Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
15217@code{main}.
15218
15219@smallexample
15220-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
15221^done,asm_insns=[
15222@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15223inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15224@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15225inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15226@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15227inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15228[@dots{}]
15229@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
15230@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
15231(@value{GDBP})
15232@end smallexample
15233
15234Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
15235
15236@smallexample
15237(@value{GDBP})
15238-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
15239^done,asm_insns=[
15240@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15241inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15242@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15243inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15244@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15245inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
15246(@value{GDBP})
15247@end smallexample
15248
15249Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
15250
15251@smallexample
15252(@value{GDBP})
15253-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
15254^done,asm_insns=[
15255src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
15256file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15257 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15258@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15259inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
15260src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
15261file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15262 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15263@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15264inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15265@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15266inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
15267(@value{GDBP})
15268@end smallexample
15269
15270
15271@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
15272@findex -data-evaluate-expression
15273
15274@subsubheading Synopsis
15275
15276@smallexample
15277 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
15278@end smallexample
15279
15280Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
15281inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
15282If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
15283
15284@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15285
15286The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
15287@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
15288@samp{gdb_eval} command.
15289
15290@subsubheading Example
15291
15292In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
15293@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
15294Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
15295output.
15296
15297@smallexample
15298211-data-evaluate-expression A
15299211^done,value="1"
15300(@value{GDBP})
15301311-data-evaluate-expression &A
15302311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
15303(@value{GDBP})
15304411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
15305411^done,value="4"
15306(@value{GDBP})
15307511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
15308511^done,value="4"
15309(@value{GDBP})
15310@end smallexample
15311
15312
15313@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
15314@findex -data-list-changed-registers
15315
15316@subsubheading Synopsis
15317
15318@smallexample
15319 -data-list-changed-registers
15320@end smallexample
15321
15322Display a list of the registers that have changed.
15323
15324@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15325
15326@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
15327has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
15328
15329@subsubheading Example
15330
15331On a PPC MBX board:
15332
15333@smallexample
15334(@value{GDBP})
15335-exec-continue
15336^running
15337
15338(@value{GDBP})
15339*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
15340args=[],file="try.c",line="5"@}
15341(@value{GDBP})
15342-data-list-changed-registers
15343^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
15344"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
15345"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
15346(@value{GDBP})
15347@end smallexample
15348
15349
15350@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
15351@findex -data-list-register-names
15352
15353@subsubheading Synopsis
15354
15355@smallexample
15356 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
15357@end smallexample
15358
15359Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
15360are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
15361integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
15362names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
15363consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
15364include empty register names.
15365
15366@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15367
15368@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
15369@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
15370corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
15371
15372@subsubheading Example
15373
15374For the PPC MBX board:
15375@smallexample
15376(@value{GDBP})
15377-data-list-register-names
15378^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
15379"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
15380"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
15381"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
15382"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
15383"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
15384"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
15385(@value{GDBP})
15386-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
15387^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
15388(@value{GDBP})
15389@end smallexample
15390
15391@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
15392@findex -data-list-register-values
15393
15394@subsubheading Synopsis
15395
15396@smallexample
15397 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
15398@end smallexample
15399
15400Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
15401which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
15402list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
15403numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
15404
15405Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
15406
15407@table @code
15408@item x
15409Hexadecimal
15410@item o
15411Octal
15412@item t
15413Binary
15414@item d
15415Decimal
15416@item r
15417Raw
15418@item N
15419Natural
15420@end table
15421
15422@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15423
15424The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
15425all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
15426
15427@subsubheading Example
15428
15429For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
15430don't appear in the actual output):
15431
15432@smallexample
15433(@value{GDBP})
15434-data-list-register-values r 64 65
15435^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15436@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
15437(@value{GDBP})
15438-data-list-register-values x
15439^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
15440@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15441@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
15442@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
15443@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
15444@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
15445@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
15446@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
15447@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
15448@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15449@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
15450@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
15451@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
15452@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
15453@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
15454@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
15455@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
15456@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
15457@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
15458@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
15459@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
15460@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
15461@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
15462@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
15463@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
15464@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
15465@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
15466@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
15467@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
15468@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
15469@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
15470@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
15471@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15472@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
15473@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
15474@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
15475(@value{GDBP})
15476@end smallexample
15477
15478
15479@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
15480@findex -data-read-memory
15481
15482@subsubheading Synopsis
15483
15484@smallexample
15485 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
15486 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
15487 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
15488@end smallexample
15489
15490@noindent
15491where:
15492
15493@table @samp
15494@item @var{address}
15495An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
15496read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
15497quoted using the C convention.
15498
15499@item @var{word-format}
15500The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
15501same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
15502,Output formats}).
15503
15504@item @var{word-size}
15505The size of each memory word in bytes.
15506
15507@item @var{nr-rows}
15508The number of rows in the output table.
15509
15510@item @var{nr-cols}
15511The number of columns in the output table.
15512
15513@item @var{aschar}
15514If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
15515value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
15516member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
15517characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
15518
15519@item @var{byte-offset}
15520An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
15521@end table
15522
15523This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
15524@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
15525@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
15526(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
15527of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
15528using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
15529in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
15530@samp{addr}.
15531
15532The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
15533@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
15534@samp{prev-page}.
15535
15536@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15537
15538The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
15539@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
15540
15541@subsubheading Example
15542
15543Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
15544@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
15545word. Display each word in hex.
15546
15547@smallexample
15548(@value{GDBP})
155499-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
155509^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
15551next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
15552prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
15553@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
15554@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
15555@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
15556(@value{GDBP})
15557@end smallexample
15558
15559Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
15560display as a single word formatted in decimal.
15561
15562@smallexample
15563(@value{GDBP})
155645-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
155655^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
15566next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
15567next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
15568@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
15569(@value{GDBP})
15570@end smallexample
15571
15572Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
15573as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
15574used as the non-printable character.
15575
15576@smallexample
15577(@value{GDBP})
155784-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
155794^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
15580next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
15581next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
15582@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15583@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15584@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15585@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15586@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
15587@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
15588@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
15589@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
15590(@value{GDBP})
15591@end smallexample
15592
15593@subheading The @code{-display-delete} Command
15594@findex -display-delete
15595
15596@subsubheading Synopsis
15597
15598@smallexample
15599 -display-delete @var{number}
15600@end smallexample
15601
15602Delete the display @var{number}.
15603
15604@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15605
15606The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete display}.
15607
15608@subsubheading Example
15609N.A.
15610
15611
15612@subheading The @code{-display-disable} Command
15613@findex -display-disable
15614
15615@subsubheading Synopsis
15616
15617@smallexample
15618 -display-disable @var{number}
15619@end smallexample
15620
15621Disable display @var{number}.
15622
15623@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15624
15625The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable display}.
15626
15627@subsubheading Example
15628N.A.
15629
15630
15631@subheading The @code{-display-enable} Command
15632@findex -display-enable
15633
15634@subsubheading Synopsis
15635
15636@smallexample
15637 -display-enable @var{number}
15638@end smallexample
15639
15640Enable display @var{number}.
15641
15642@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15643
15644The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable display}.
15645
15646@subsubheading Example
15647N.A.
15648
15649
15650@subheading The @code{-display-insert} Command
15651@findex -display-insert
15652
15653@subsubheading Synopsis
15654
15655@smallexample
15656 -display-insert @var{expression}
15657@end smallexample
15658
15659Display @var{expression} every time the program stops.
15660
15661@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15662
15663The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{display}.
15664
15665@subsubheading Example
15666N.A.
15667
15668
15669@subheading The @code{-display-list} Command
15670@findex -display-list
15671
15672@subsubheading Synopsis
15673
15674@smallexample
15675 -display-list
15676@end smallexample
15677
15678List the displays. Do not show the current values.
15679
15680@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15681
15682The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info display}.
15683
15684@subsubheading Example
15685N.A.
15686
15687
15688@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
15689@findex -environment-cd
15690
15691@subsubheading Synopsis
15692
15693@smallexample
15694 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
15695@end smallexample
15696
15697Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
15698
15699@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15700
15701The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
15702
15703@subsubheading Example
15704
15705@smallexample
15706(@value{GDBP})
15707-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15708^done
15709(@value{GDBP})
15710@end smallexample
15711
15712
15713@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
15714@findex -environment-directory
15715
15716@subsubheading Synopsis
15717
15718@smallexample
15719 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15720@end smallexample
15721
15722Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
15723If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
15724search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
15725@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15726occurs as normal.
15727Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15728multiple directories in a single command
15729results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15730search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15731If blanks are needed as
15732part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
15733the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
15734by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
15735character must not be used
15736in any directory name.
15737If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
15738
15739@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15740
15741The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
15742
15743@subsubheading Example
15744
15745@smallexample
15746(@value{GDBP})
15747-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15748^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
15749(@value{GDBP})
15750-environment-directory ""
15751^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
15752(@value{GDBP})
15753-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
15754^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
15755(@value{GDBP})
15756-environment-directory -r
15757^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
15758(@value{GDBP})
15759@end smallexample
15760
15761
15762@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
15763@findex -environment-path
15764
15765@subsubheading Synopsis
15766
15767@smallexample
15768 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15769@end smallexample
15770
15771Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
15772If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
15773search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
15774supplied in addition to the
15775@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15776occurs as normal.
15777Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15778multiple directories in a single command
15779results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15780search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15781If blanks are needed as
15782part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
15783the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
15784by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
15785character must not be used
15786in any directory name.
15787If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
15788
15789
15790@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15791
15792The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
15793
15794@subsubheading Example
15795
15796@smallexample
15797(@value{GDBP})
15798-environment-path
15799^done,path="/usr/bin"
15800(@value{GDBP})
15801-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
15802^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
15803(@value{GDBP})
15804-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
15805^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
15806(@value{GDBP})
15807@end smallexample
15808
15809
15810@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
15811@findex -environment-pwd
15812
15813@subsubheading Synopsis
15814
15815@smallexample
15816 -environment-pwd
15817@end smallexample
15818
15819Show the current working directory.
15820
15821@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
15822
15823The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
15824
15825@subsubheading Example
15826
15827@smallexample
15828(@value{GDBP})
15829-environment-pwd
15830^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
15831(@value{GDBP})
15832@end smallexample
15833
15834@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15835@node GDB/MI Program Control
15836@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program control
15837
15838@subsubheading Program termination
15839
15840As a result of execution, the inferior program can run to completion, if
15841it doesn't encounter any breakpoints. In this case the output will
15842include an exit code, if the program has exited exceptionally.
15843
15844@subsubheading Examples
15845
15846@noindent
15847Program exited normally:
15848
15849@smallexample
15850(@value{GDBP})
15851-exec-run
15852^running
15853(@value{GDBP})
15854x = 55
15855*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
15856(@value{GDBP})
15857@end smallexample
15858
15859@noindent
15860Program exited exceptionally:
15861
15862@smallexample
15863(@value{GDBP})
15864-exec-run
15865^running
15866(@value{GDBP})
15867x = 55
15868*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
15869(@value{GDBP})
15870@end smallexample
15871
15872Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
15873@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
15874
15875@smallexample
15876(@value{GDBP})
15877*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
15878signal-meaning="Interrupt"
15879@end smallexample
15880
15881
15882@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
15883@findex -exec-abort
15884
15885@subsubheading Synopsis
15886
15887@smallexample
15888 -exec-abort
15889@end smallexample
15890
15891Kill the inferior running program.
15892
15893@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15894
15895The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
15896
15897@subsubheading Example
15898N.A.
15899
15900
15901@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
15902@findex -exec-arguments
15903
15904@subsubheading Synopsis
15905
15906@smallexample
15907 -exec-arguments @var{args}
15908@end smallexample
15909
15910Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
15911@samp{-exec-run}.
15912
15913@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15914
15915The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
15916
15917@subsubheading Example
15918
15919@c FIXME!
15920Don't have one around.
15921
15922
15923@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
15924@findex -exec-continue
15925
15926@subsubheading Synopsis
15927
15928@smallexample
15929 -exec-continue
15930@end smallexample
15931
15932Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
15933until a breakpoint is encountered, or until the inferior exits.
15934
15935@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15936
15937The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
15938
15939@subsubheading Example
15940
15941@smallexample
15942-exec-continue
15943^running
15944(@value{GDBP})
15945@@Hello world
15946*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
15947file="hello.c",line="13"@}
15948(@value{GDBP})
15949@end smallexample
15950
15951
15952@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
15953@findex -exec-finish
15954
15955@subsubheading Synopsis
15956
15957@smallexample
15958 -exec-finish
15959@end smallexample
15960
15961Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
15962until the current function is exited. Displays the results returned by
15963the function.
15964
15965@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15966
15967The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
15968
15969@subsubheading Example
15970
15971Function returning @code{void}.
15972
15973@smallexample
15974-exec-finish
15975^running
15976(@value{GDBP})
15977@@hello from foo
15978*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
15979file="hello.c",line="7"@}
15980(@value{GDBP})
15981@end smallexample
15982
15983Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
15984@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
15985value itself.
15986
15987@smallexample
15988-exec-finish
15989^running
15990(@value{GDBP})
15991*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
15992args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
15993file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
15994gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
15995(@value{GDBP})
15996@end smallexample
15997
15998
15999@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
16000@findex -exec-interrupt
16001
16002@subsubheading Synopsis
16003
16004@smallexample
16005 -exec-interrupt
16006@end smallexample
16007
16008Asynchronous command. Interrupts the background execution of the target.
16009Note how the token associated with the stop message is the one for the
16010execution command that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt
16011itself only appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
16012interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
16013
16014@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16015
16016The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
16017
16018@subsubheading Example
16019
16020@smallexample
16021(@value{GDBP})
16022111-exec-continue
16023111^running
16024
16025(@value{GDBP})
16026222-exec-interrupt
16027222^done
16028(@value{GDBP})
16029111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
16030frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="13"@}
16031(@value{GDBP})
16032
16033(@value{GDBP})
16034-exec-interrupt
16035^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
16036(@value{GDBP})
16037@end smallexample
16038
16039
16040@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
16041@findex -exec-next
16042
16043@subsubheading Synopsis
16044
16045@smallexample
16046 -exec-next
16047@end smallexample
16048
16049Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16050when the beginning of the next source line is reached.
16051
16052@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16053
16054The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
16055
16056@subsubheading Example
16057
16058@smallexample
16059-exec-next
16060^running
16061(@value{GDBP})
16062*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
16063(@value{GDBP})
16064@end smallexample
16065
16066
16067@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
16068@findex -exec-next-instruction
16069
16070@subsubheading Synopsis
16071
16072@smallexample
16073 -exec-next-instruction
16074@end smallexample
16075
16076Asynchronous command. Executes one machine instruction. If the
16077instruction is a function call continues until the function returns. If
16078the program stops at an instruction in the middle of a source line, the
16079address will be printed as well.
16080
16081@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16082
16083The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
16084
16085@subsubheading Example
16086
16087@smallexample
16088(@value{GDBP})
16089-exec-next-instruction
16090^running
16091
16092(@value{GDBP})
16093*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16094addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
16095(@value{GDBP})
16096@end smallexample
16097
16098
16099@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
16100@findex -exec-return
16101
16102@subsubheading Synopsis
16103
16104@smallexample
16105 -exec-return
16106@end smallexample
16107
16108Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
16109Displays the new current frame.
16110
16111@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16112
16113The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
16114
16115@subsubheading Example
16116
16117@smallexample
16118(@value{GDBP})
16119200-break-insert callee4
16120200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
16121file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16122(@value{GDBP})
16123000-exec-run
16124000^running
16125(@value{GDBP})
16126000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16127frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
16128file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16129(@value{GDBP})
16130205-break-delete
16131205^done
16132(@value{GDBP})
16133111-exec-return
16134111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
16135args=[@{name="strarg",
16136value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
16137file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
16138(@value{GDBP})
16139@end smallexample
16140
16141
16142@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
16143@findex -exec-run
16144
16145@subsubheading Synopsis
16146
16147@smallexample
16148 -exec-run
16149@end smallexample
16150
16151Asynchronous command. Starts execution of the inferior from the
16152beginning. The inferior executes until either a breakpoint is
16153encountered or the program exits.
16154
16155@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16156
16157The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
16158
16159@subsubheading Example
16160
16161@smallexample
16162(@value{GDBP})
16163-break-insert main
16164^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16165(@value{GDBP})
16166-exec-run
16167^running
16168(@value{GDBP})
16169*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16170frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16171(@value{GDBP})
16172@end smallexample
16173
16174
16175@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
16176@findex -exec-show-arguments
16177
16178@subsubheading Synopsis
16179
16180@smallexample
16181 -exec-show-arguments
16182@end smallexample
16183
16184Print the arguments of the program.
16185
16186@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16187
16188The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
16189
16190@subsubheading Example
16191N.A.
16192
16193@c @subheading -exec-signal
16194
16195@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
16196@findex -exec-step
16197
16198@subsubheading Synopsis
16199
16200@smallexample
16201 -exec-step
16202@end smallexample
16203
16204Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16205when the beginning of the next source line is reached, if the next
16206source line is not a function call. If it is, stop at the first
16207instruction of the called function.
16208
16209@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16210
16211The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
16212
16213@subsubheading Example
16214
16215Stepping into a function:
16216
16217@smallexample
16218-exec-step
16219^running
16220(@value{GDBP})
16221*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16222frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
16223@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
16224(@value{GDBP})
16225@end smallexample
16226
16227Regular stepping:
16228
16229@smallexample
16230-exec-step
16231^running
16232(@value{GDBP})
16233*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
16234(@value{GDBP})
16235@end smallexample
16236
16237
16238@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
16239@findex -exec-step-instruction
16240
16241@subsubheading Synopsis
16242
16243@smallexample
16244 -exec-step-instruction
16245@end smallexample
16246
16247Asynchronous command. Resumes the inferior which executes one machine
16248instruction. The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
16249whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
16250former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
16251well.
16252
16253@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16254
16255The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
16256
16257@subsubheading Example
16258
16259@smallexample
16260(@value{GDBP})
16261-exec-step-instruction
16262^running
16263
16264(@value{GDBP})
16265*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16266frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16267(@value{GDBP})
16268-exec-step-instruction
16269^running
16270
16271(@value{GDBP})
16272*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16273frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16274(@value{GDBP})
16275@end smallexample
16276
16277
16278@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
16279@findex -exec-until
16280
16281@subsubheading Synopsis
16282
16283@smallexample
16284 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
16285@end smallexample
16286
16287Asynchronous command. Executes the inferior until the @var{location}
16288specified in the argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior
16289executes until a source line greater than the current one is reached.
16290The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
16291
16292@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16293
16294The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
16295
16296@subsubheading Example
16297
16298@smallexample
16299(@value{GDBP})
16300-exec-until recursive2.c:6
16301^running
16302(@value{GDBP})
16303x = 55
16304*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16305file="recursive2.c",line="6"@}
16306(@value{GDBP})
16307@end smallexample
16308
16309@ignore
16310@subheading -file-clear
16311Is this going away????
16312@end ignore
16313
16314
16315@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
16316@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
16317
16318@subsubheading Synopsis
16319
16320@smallexample
16321 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
16322@end smallexample
16323
16324Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
16325which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
16326command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
16327are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
16328error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
16329notification.
16330
16331@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16332
16333The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
16334
16335@subsubheading Example
16336
16337@smallexample
16338(@value{GDBP})
16339-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16340^done
16341(@value{GDBP})
16342@end smallexample
16343
16344
16345@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
16346@findex -file-exec-file
16347
16348@subsubheading Synopsis
16349
16350@smallexample
16351 -file-exec-file @var{file}
16352@end smallexample
16353
16354Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
16355@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
16356from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
16357about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
16358notification.
16359
16360@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16361
16362The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
16363
16364@subsubheading Example
16365
16366@smallexample
16367(@value{GDBP})
16368-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16369^done
16370(@value{GDBP})
16371@end smallexample
16372
16373
16374@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
16375@findex -file-list-exec-sections
16376
16377@subsubheading Synopsis
16378
16379@smallexample
16380 -file-list-exec-sections
16381@end smallexample
16382
16383List the sections of the current executable file.
16384
16385@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16386
16387The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
16388information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
16389@samp{gdb_load_info}.
16390
16391@subsubheading Example
16392N.A.
16393
16394
1abaf70c
BR
16395@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
16396@findex -file-list-exec-source-file
16397
16398@subsubheading Synopsis
16399
16400@smallexample
16401 -file-list-exec-source-file
16402@end smallexample
16403
16404List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
16405to the current source file for the current executable.
16406
16407@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16408
16409There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16410
16411@subsubheading Example
16412
16413@smallexample
16414(@value{GDBP})
16415123-file-list-exec-source-file
16416123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
16417(@value{GDBP})
16418@end smallexample
16419
16420
922fbb7b
AC
16421@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
16422@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
16423
16424@subsubheading Synopsis
16425
16426@smallexample
16427 -file-list-exec-source-files
16428@end smallexample
16429
16430List the source files for the current executable.
16431
16432@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16433
16434There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16435@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
16436
16437@subsubheading Example
16438N.A.
16439
16440
16441@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
16442@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
16443
16444@subsubheading Synopsis
16445
16446@smallexample
16447 -file-list-shared-libraries
16448@end smallexample
16449
16450List the shared libraries in the program.
16451
16452@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16453
16454The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
16455
16456@subsubheading Example
16457N.A.
16458
16459
16460@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
16461@findex -file-list-symbol-files
16462
16463@subsubheading Synopsis
16464
16465@smallexample
16466 -file-list-symbol-files
16467@end smallexample
16468
16469List symbol files.
16470
16471@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16472
16473The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
16474
16475@subsubheading Example
16476N.A.
16477
16478
16479@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
16480@findex -file-symbol-file
16481
16482@subsubheading Synopsis
16483
16484@smallexample
16485 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
16486@end smallexample
16487
16488Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
16489used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
16490produced, except for a completion notification.
16491
16492@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16493
16494The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
16495
16496@subsubheading Example
16497
16498@smallexample
16499(@value{GDBP})
16500-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16501^done
16502(@value{GDBP})
16503@end smallexample
16504
16505@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16506@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
16507@section Miscellaneous @value{GDBN} commands in @sc{gdb/mi}
16508
16509@c @subheading -gdb-complete
16510
16511@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
16512@findex -gdb-exit
16513
16514@subsubheading Synopsis
16515
16516@smallexample
16517 -gdb-exit
16518@end smallexample
16519
16520Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
16521
16522@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16523
16524Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
16525
16526@subsubheading Example
16527
16528@smallexample
16529(@value{GDBP})
16530-gdb-exit
16531@end smallexample
16532
16533@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
16534@findex -gdb-set
16535
16536@subsubheading Synopsis
16537
16538@smallexample
16539 -gdb-set
16540@end smallexample
16541
16542Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
16543@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
16544
16545@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16546
16547The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
16548
16549@subsubheading Example
16550
16551@smallexample
16552(@value{GDBP})
16553-gdb-set $foo=3
16554^done
16555(@value{GDBP})
16556@end smallexample
16557
16558
16559@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
16560@findex -gdb-show
16561
16562@subsubheading Synopsis
16563
16564@smallexample
16565 -gdb-show
16566@end smallexample
16567
16568Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
16569
16570@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
16571
16572The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
16573
16574@subsubheading Example
16575
16576@smallexample
16577(@value{GDBP})
16578-gdb-show annotate
16579^done,value="0"
16580(@value{GDBP})
16581@end smallexample
16582
16583@c @subheading -gdb-source
16584
16585
16586@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
16587@findex -gdb-version
16588
16589@subsubheading Synopsis
16590
16591@smallexample
16592 -gdb-version
16593@end smallexample
16594
16595Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
16596
16597@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16598
16599There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @value{GDBN} by default shows this
16600information when you start an interactive session.
16601
16602@subsubheading Example
16603
16604@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
16605@c box in TeX.
16606@smallexample
16607(@value{GDBP})
16608-gdb-version
16609~GNU gdb 5.2.1
16610~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
16611~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
16612~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
16613~ certain conditions.
16614~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
16615~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
16616~ details.
16617~This GDB was configured as
16618 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
16619^done
16620(@value{GDBP})
16621@end smallexample
16622
16623@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
16624@findex -interpreter-exec
16625
16626@subheading Synopsis
16627
16628@smallexample
16629-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
16630@end smallexample
16631
16632Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
16633
16634@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
16635
16636The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
16637
16638@subheading Example
16639
16640@smallexample
16641(@value{GDBP})
16642-interpreter-exec console "break main"
16643&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
16644&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
16645~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
16646^done
16647(@value{GDBP})
16648@end smallexample
16649
16650@ignore
16651@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16652@node GDB/MI Kod Commands
16653@section @sc{gdb/mi} Kod Commands
16654
16655The Kod commands are not implemented.
16656
16657@c @subheading -kod-info
16658
16659@c @subheading -kod-list
16660
16661@c @subheading -kod-list-object-types
16662
16663@c @subheading -kod-show
16664
16665@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16666@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
16667@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
16668
16669The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
16670
16671@c @subheading -overlay-auto
16672
16673@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
16674
16675@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
16676
16677@c @subheading -overlay-map
16678
16679@c @subheading -overlay-off
16680
16681@c @subheading -overlay-on
16682
16683@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
16684
16685@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16686@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
16687@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
16688
16689Signal handling commands are not implemented.
16690
16691@c @subheading -signal-handle
16692
16693@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
16694
16695@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
16696@end ignore
16697
16698
16699@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16700@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
16701@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
16702
16703
16704@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
16705@findex -stack-info-frame
16706
16707@subsubheading Synopsis
16708
16709@smallexample
16710 -stack-info-frame
16711@end smallexample
16712
16713Get info on the current frame.
16714
16715@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16716
16717The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
16718(without arguments).
16719
16720@subsubheading Example
16721N.A.
16722
16723@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
16724@findex -stack-info-depth
16725
16726@subsubheading Synopsis
16727
16728@smallexample
16729 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
16730@end smallexample
16731
16732Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
16733is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
16734
16735@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16736
16737There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
16738
16739@subsubheading Example
16740
16741For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
16742
16743@smallexample
16744(@value{GDBP})
16745-stack-info-depth
16746^done,depth="12"
16747(@value{GDBP})
16748-stack-info-depth 4
16749^done,depth="4"
16750(@value{GDBP})
16751-stack-info-depth 12
16752^done,depth="12"
16753(@value{GDBP})
16754-stack-info-depth 11
16755^done,depth="11"
16756(@value{GDBP})
16757-stack-info-depth 13
16758^done,depth="12"
16759(@value{GDBP})
16760@end smallexample
16761
16762@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
16763@findex -stack-list-arguments
16764
16765@subsubheading Synopsis
16766
16767@smallexample
16768 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
16769 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
16770@end smallexample
16771
16772Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
16773and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
16774@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
16775stack.
16776
16777The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
167780 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
16779means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
16780
16781@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16782
16783@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
16784@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
16785functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
16786
16787@subsubheading Example
16788
16789@smallexample
16790(@value{GDBP})
16791-stack-list-frames
16792^done,
16793stack=[
16794frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
16795file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
16796frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
16797file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
16798frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
16799file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
16800frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
16801file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
16802frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
16803file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
16804(@value{GDBP})
16805-stack-list-arguments 0
16806^done,
16807stack-args=[
16808frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
16809frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
16810frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
16811frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
16812frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
16813(@value{GDBP})
16814-stack-list-arguments 1
16815^done,
16816stack-args=[
16817frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
16818frame=@{level="1",
16819 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
16820frame=@{level="2",args=[
16821@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16822@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
16823@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
16824@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16825@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
16826@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
16827frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
16828(@value{GDBP})
16829-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
16830^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
16831(@value{GDBP})
16832-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
16833^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
16834args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16835@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
16836(@value{GDBP})
16837@end smallexample
16838
16839@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
16840
16841
16842@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
16843@findex -stack-list-frames
16844
16845@subsubheading Synopsis
16846
16847@smallexample
16848 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
16849@end smallexample
16850
16851List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
16852following info:
16853
16854@table @samp
16855@item @var{level}
16856The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
16857@item @var{addr}
16858The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
16859@item @var{func}
16860Function name.
16861@item @var{file}
16862File name of the source file where the function lives.
16863@item @var{line}
16864Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
16865@end table
16866
16867If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
16868whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
16869levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
16870are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
16871
16872@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16873
16874The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
16875
16876@subsubheading Example
16877
16878Full stack backtrace:
16879
16880@smallexample
16881(@value{GDBP})
16882-stack-list-frames
16883^done,stack=
16884[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
16885 file="recursive2.c",line="11"@},
16886frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16887 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16888frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16889 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16890frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16891 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16892frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16893 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16894frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16895 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16896frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16897 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16898frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16899 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16900frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16901 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16902frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16903 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16904frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16905 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16906frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
16907 file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
16908(@value{GDBP})
16909@end smallexample
16910
16911Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
16912
16913@smallexample
16914(@value{GDBP})
16915-stack-list-frames 3 5
16916^done,stack=
16917[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16918 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16919frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16920 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16921frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16922 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
16923(@value{GDBP})
16924@end smallexample
16925
16926Show a single frame:
16927
16928@smallexample
16929(@value{GDBP})
16930-stack-list-frames 3 3
16931^done,stack=
16932[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
16933 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
16934(@value{GDBP})
16935@end smallexample
16936
16937
16938@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
16939@findex -stack-list-locals
16940
16941@subsubheading Synopsis
16942
16943@smallexample
16944 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
16945@end smallexample
16946
16947Display the local variable names for the current frame. With an
16948argument of 0 prints only the names of the variables, with argument of 1
16949prints also their values.
16950
16951@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16952
16953@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
16954
16955@subsubheading Example
16956
16957@smallexample
16958(@value{GDBP})
16959-stack-list-locals 0
16960^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
16961(@value{GDBP})
16962-stack-list-locals 1
16963^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
16964 @{name="C",value="3"@}]
16965(@value{GDBP})
16966@end smallexample
16967
16968
16969@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
16970@findex -stack-select-frame
16971
16972@subsubheading Synopsis
16973
16974@smallexample
16975 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
16976@end smallexample
16977
16978Change the current frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
16979the stack.
16980
16981@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16982
16983The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
16984@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
16985
16986@subsubheading Example
16987
16988@smallexample
16989(@value{GDBP})
16990-stack-select-frame 2
16991^done
16992(@value{GDBP})
16993@end smallexample
16994
16995@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16996@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
16997@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
16998
16999
17000@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
17001@findex -symbol-info-address
17002
17003@subsubheading Synopsis
17004
17005@smallexample
17006 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
17007@end smallexample
17008
17009Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
17010
17011@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17012
17013The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
17014
17015@subsubheading Example
17016N.A.
17017
17018
17019@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
17020@findex -symbol-info-file
17021
17022@subsubheading Synopsis
17023
17024@smallexample
17025 -symbol-info-file
17026@end smallexample
17027
17028Show the file for the symbol.
17029
17030@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17031
17032There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
17033@samp{gdb_find_file}.
17034
17035@subsubheading Example
17036N.A.
17037
17038
17039@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
17040@findex -symbol-info-function
17041
17042@subsubheading Synopsis
17043
17044@smallexample
17045 -symbol-info-function
17046@end smallexample
17047
17048Show which function the symbol lives in.
17049
17050@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17051
17052@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
17053
17054@subsubheading Example
17055N.A.
17056
17057
17058@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
17059@findex -symbol-info-line
17060
17061@subsubheading Synopsis
17062
17063@smallexample
17064 -symbol-info-line
17065@end smallexample
17066
17067Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
17068
17069@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17070
17071The corresponding @value{GDBN} comamnd is @samp{info line}.
17072@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
17073
17074@subsubheading Example
17075N.A.
17076
17077
17078@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
17079@findex -symbol-info-symbol
17080
17081@subsubheading Synopsis
17082
17083@smallexample
17084 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
17085@end smallexample
17086
17087Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
17088
17089@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17090
17091The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
17092
17093@subsubheading Example
17094N.A.
17095
17096
17097@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
17098@findex -symbol-list-functions
17099
17100@subsubheading Synopsis
17101
17102@smallexample
17103 -symbol-list-functions
17104@end smallexample
17105
17106List the functions in the executable.
17107
17108@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17109
17110@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
17111@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17112
17113@subsubheading Example
17114N.A.
17115
17116
32e7087d
JB
17117@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
17118@findex -symbol-list-lines
17119
17120@subsubheading Synopsis
17121
17122@smallexample
17123 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
17124@end smallexample
17125
17126Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
17127addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
17128ascending PC order.
17129
17130@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17131
17132There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
17133
17134@subsubheading Example
17135@smallexample
17136(@value{GDBP})
17137-symbol-list-lines basics.c
54ff5908 17138^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32e7087d
JB
17139(@value{GDBP})
17140@end smallexample
17141
17142
922fbb7b
AC
17143@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
17144@findex -symbol-list-types
17145
17146@subsubheading Synopsis
17147
17148@smallexample
17149 -symbol-list-types
17150@end smallexample
17151
17152List all the type names.
17153
17154@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17155
17156The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
17157@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17158
17159@subsubheading Example
17160N.A.
17161
17162
17163@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
17164@findex -symbol-list-variables
17165
17166@subsubheading Synopsis
17167
17168@smallexample
17169 -symbol-list-variables
17170@end smallexample
17171
17172List all the global and static variable names.
17173
17174@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17175
17176@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17177
17178@subsubheading Example
17179N.A.
17180
17181
17182@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
17183@findex -symbol-locate
17184
17185@subsubheading Synopsis
17186
17187@smallexample
17188 -symbol-locate
17189@end smallexample
17190
17191@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17192
17193@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
17194
17195@subsubheading Example
17196N.A.
17197
17198
17199@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
17200@findex -symbol-type
17201
17202@subsubheading Synopsis
17203
17204@smallexample
17205 -symbol-type @var{variable}
17206@end smallexample
17207
17208Show type of @var{variable}.
17209
17210@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17211
17212The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
17213@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
17214
17215@subsubheading Example
17216N.A.
17217
17218
17219@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17220@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
17221@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
17222
17223
17224@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
17225@findex -target-attach
17226
17227@subsubheading Synopsis
17228
17229@smallexample
17230 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
17231@end smallexample
17232
17233Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
17234
17235@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17236
17237The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
17238
17239@subsubheading Example
17240N.A.
17241
17242
17243@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
17244@findex -target-compare-sections
17245
17246@subsubheading Synopsis
17247
17248@smallexample
17249 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
17250@end smallexample
17251
17252Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
17253Without the argument, all sections are compared.
17254
17255@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17256
17257The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
17258
17259@subsubheading Example
17260N.A.
17261
17262
17263@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
17264@findex -target-detach
17265
17266@subsubheading Synopsis
17267
17268@smallexample
17269 -target-detach
17270@end smallexample
17271
17272Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17273
17274@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17275
17276The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
17277
17278@subsubheading Example
17279
17280@smallexample
17281(@value{GDBP})
17282-target-detach
17283^done
17284(@value{GDBP})
17285@end smallexample
17286
17287
17288@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
17289@findex -target-download
17290
17291@subsubheading Synopsis
17292
17293@smallexample
17294 -target-download
17295@end smallexample
17296
17297Loads the executable onto the remote target.
17298It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
17299
17300@table @samp
17301@item section
17302The name of the section.
17303@item section-sent
17304The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
17305@item section-size
17306The size of the section.
17307@item total-sent
17308The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
17309@item total-size
17310The size of the overall executable to download.
17311@end table
17312
17313@noindent
17314Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
17315@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
17316
17317In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
17318downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
17319
17320@table @samp
17321@item section
17322The name of the section.
17323@item section-size
17324The size of the section.
17325@item total-size
17326The size of the overall executable to download.
17327@end table
17328
17329@noindent
17330At the end, a summary is printed.
17331
17332@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17333
17334The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
17335
17336@subsubheading Example
17337
17338Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
17339have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
17340
17341@smallexample
17342(@value{GDBP})
17343-target-download
17344+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
17345+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
17346total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
17347+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
17348total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
17349+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
17350total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
17351+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
17352total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
17353+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
17354total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
17355+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
17356total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
17357+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
17358total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
17359+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
17360total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
17361+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
17362total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
17363+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
17364total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
17365+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
17366total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
17367+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
17368total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
17369+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
17370total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
17371+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17372+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17373+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
17374+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
17375total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
17376+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
17377total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
17378+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
17379total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
17380+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
17381total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
17382+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
17383total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
17384+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
17385total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
17386^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
17387write-rate="429"
17388(@value{GDBP})
17389@end smallexample
17390
17391
17392@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
17393@findex -target-exec-status
17394
17395@subsubheading Synopsis
17396
17397@smallexample
17398 -target-exec-status
17399@end smallexample
17400
17401Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
17402not, for instance).
17403
17404@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17405
17406There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
17407
17408@subsubheading Example
17409N.A.
17410
17411
17412@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
17413@findex -target-list-available-targets
17414
17415@subsubheading Synopsis
17416
17417@smallexample
17418 -target-list-available-targets
17419@end smallexample
17420
17421List the possible targets to connect to.
17422
17423@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17424
17425The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
17426
17427@subsubheading Example
17428N.A.
17429
17430
17431@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
17432@findex -target-list-current-targets
17433
17434@subsubheading Synopsis
17435
17436@smallexample
17437 -target-list-current-targets
17438@end smallexample
17439
17440Describe the current target.
17441
17442@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17443
17444The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
17445other things).
17446
17447@subsubheading Example
17448N.A.
17449
17450
17451@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
17452@findex -target-list-parameters
17453
17454@subsubheading Synopsis
17455
17456@smallexample
17457 -target-list-parameters
17458@end smallexample
17459
17460@c ????
17461
17462@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17463
17464No equivalent.
17465
17466@subsubheading Example
17467N.A.
17468
17469
17470@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
17471@findex -target-select
17472
17473@subsubheading Synopsis
17474
17475@smallexample
17476 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
17477@end smallexample
17478
17479Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
17480
17481@table @samp
17482@item @var{type}
17483The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
17484@item @var{parameters}
17485Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
17486Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
17487@end table
17488
17489The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
17490which the target program is, in the following form:
17491
17492@smallexample
17493^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
17494 args=[@var{arg list}]
17495@end smallexample
17496
17497@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17498
17499The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
17500
17501@subsubheading Example
17502
17503@smallexample
17504(@value{GDBP})
17505-target-select async /dev/ttya
17506^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
17507(@value{GDBP})
17508@end smallexample
17509
17510@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17511@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
17512@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
17513
17514
17515@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
17516@findex -thread-info
17517
17518@subsubheading Synopsis
17519
17520@smallexample
17521 -thread-info
17522@end smallexample
17523
17524@subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17525
17526No equivalent.
17527
17528@subsubheading Example
17529N.A.
17530
17531
17532@subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
17533@findex -thread-list-all-threads
17534
17535@subsubheading Synopsis
17536
17537@smallexample
17538 -thread-list-all-threads
17539@end smallexample
17540
17541@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17542
17543The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
17544
17545@subsubheading Example
17546N.A.
17547
17548
17549@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
17550@findex -thread-list-ids
17551
17552@subsubheading Synopsis
17553
17554@smallexample
17555 -thread-list-ids
17556@end smallexample
17557
17558Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
17559end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
17560
17561@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17562
17563Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
17564
17565@subsubheading Example
17566
17567No threads present, besides the main process:
17568
17569@smallexample
17570(@value{GDBP})
17571-thread-list-ids
17572^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
17573(@value{GDBP})
17574@end smallexample
17575
17576
17577Several threads:
17578
17579@smallexample
17580(@value{GDBP})
17581-thread-list-ids
17582^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17583number-of-threads="3"
17584(@value{GDBP})
17585@end smallexample
17586
17587
17588@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
17589@findex -thread-select
17590
17591@subsubheading Synopsis
17592
17593@smallexample
17594 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
17595@end smallexample
17596
17597Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
17598current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
17599
17600@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17601
17602The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
17603
17604@subsubheading Example
17605
17606@smallexample
17607(@value{GDBP})
17608-exec-next
17609^running
17610(@value{GDBP})
17611*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
17612file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
17613(@value{GDBP})
17614-thread-list-ids
17615^done,
17616thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17617number-of-threads="3"
17618(@value{GDBP})
17619-thread-select 3
17620^done,new-thread-id="3",
17621frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
17622args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
17623@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
17624(@value{GDBP})
17625@end smallexample
17626
17627@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17628@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
17629@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
17630
17631The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
17632
17633@c @subheading -trace-actions
17634
17635@c @subheading -trace-delete
17636
17637@c @subheading -trace-disable
17638
17639@c @subheading -trace-dump
17640
17641@c @subheading -trace-enable
17642
17643@c @subheading -trace-exists
17644
17645@c @subheading -trace-find
17646
17647@c @subheading -trace-frame-number
17648
17649@c @subheading -trace-info
17650
17651@c @subheading -trace-insert
17652
17653@c @subheading -trace-list
17654
17655@c @subheading -trace-pass-count
17656
17657@c @subheading -trace-save
17658
17659@c @subheading -trace-start
17660
17661@c @subheading -trace-stop
17662
17663
17664@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17665@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
17666@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
17667
17668
17669@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17670
17671For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
17672expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
17673used by @code{Insight}.
17674
17675The two main reasons for that are:
17676
17677@enumerate 1
17678@item
17679It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
17680
17681@item
17682It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
17683now).
17684@end enumerate
17685
17686The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
17687slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
17688describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
17689hints about their use.
17690
17691@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
17692expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
17693least, the following operations:
17694
17695@itemize @bullet
17696@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
17697@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
17698@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
17699@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
17700@end itemize
17701
17702@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17703
17704@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17705The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
17706to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
17707register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
17708examining or changing its properties.
17709
17710Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
17711in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
17712root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
17713is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
17714Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
17715
17716When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
17717for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
17718creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
17719and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
17720chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
17721for pointers, etc.).
17722
17723The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
17724access this functionality:
17725
17726@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
17727@item @strong{Operation}
17728@tab @strong{Description}
17729
17730@item @code{-var-create}
17731@tab create a variable object
17732@item @code{-var-delete}
17733@tab delete the variable object and its children
17734@item @code{-var-set-format}
17735@tab set the display format of this variable
17736@item @code{-var-show-format}
17737@tab show the display format of this variable
17738@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
17739@tab tells how many children this object has
17740@item @code{-var-list-children}
17741@tab return a list of the object's children
17742@item @code{-var-info-type}
17743@tab show the type of this variable object
17744@item @code{-var-info-expression}
17745@tab print what this variable object represents
17746@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
17747@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
17748@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
17749@tab get the value of this variable
17750@item @code{-var-assign}
17751@tab set the value of this variable
17752@item @code{-var-update}
17753@tab update the variable and its children
17754@end multitable
17755
17756In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
17757how it can be used.
17758
17759@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
17760
17761@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
17762@findex -var-create
17763
17764@subsubheading Synopsis
17765
17766@smallexample
17767 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
17768 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
17769@end smallexample
17770
17771This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
17772a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
17773register.
17774
17775The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
17776referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
17777system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
17778unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
17779The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
17780
17781The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
17782specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
17783frame should be used.
17784
17785@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
17786begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
17787
17788@itemize @bullet
17789@item
17790@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
17791
17792@item
17793@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
17794
17795@item
17796@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
17797@end itemize
17798
17799@subsubheading Result
17800
17801This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
17802object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
17803the @value{GDBN} CLI:
17804
17805@smallexample
17806 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
17807@end smallexample
17808
17809
17810@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
17811@findex -var-delete
17812
17813@subsubheading Synopsis
17814
17815@smallexample
17816 -var-delete @var{name}
17817@end smallexample
17818
17819Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
17820
17821Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
17822
17823
17824@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
17825@findex -var-set-format
17826
17827@subsubheading Synopsis
17828
17829@smallexample
17830 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
17831@end smallexample
17832
17833Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
17834@var{format-spec}.
17835
17836The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
17837
17838@smallexample
17839 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
17840 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
17841@end smallexample
17842
17843
17844@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
17845@findex -var-show-format
17846
17847@subsubheading Synopsis
17848
17849@smallexample
17850 -var-show-format @var{name}
17851@end smallexample
17852
17853Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
17854
17855@smallexample
17856 @var{format} @expansion{}
17857 @var{format-spec}
17858@end smallexample
17859
17860
17861@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
17862@findex -var-info-num-children
17863
17864@subsubheading Synopsis
17865
17866@smallexample
17867 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
17868@end smallexample
17869
17870Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
17871
17872@smallexample
17873 numchild=@var{n}
17874@end smallexample
17875
17876
17877@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
17878@findex -var-list-children
17879
17880@subsubheading Synopsis
17881
17882@smallexample
17883 -var-list-children @var{name}
17884@end smallexample
17885
17886Returns a list of the children of the specified variable object:
17887
17888@smallexample
17889 numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
17890 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
17891@end smallexample
17892
17893
17894@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
17895@findex -var-info-type
17896
17897@subsubheading Synopsis
17898
17899@smallexample
17900 -var-info-type @var{name}
17901@end smallexample
17902
17903Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
17904returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
17905@value{GDBN} CLI:
17906
17907@smallexample
17908 type=@var{typename}
17909@end smallexample
17910
17911
17912@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
17913@findex -var-info-expression
17914
17915@subsubheading Synopsis
17916
17917@smallexample
17918 -var-info-expression @var{name}
17919@end smallexample
17920
17921Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
17922
17923@smallexample
17924 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
17925@end smallexample
17926
17927@noindent
17928where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
17929
17930@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
17931@findex -var-show-attributes
17932
17933@subsubheading Synopsis
17934
17935@smallexample
17936 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
17937@end smallexample
17938
17939List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
17940
17941@smallexample
17942 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
17943@end smallexample
17944
17945@noindent
17946where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
17947
17948@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
17949@findex -var-evaluate-expression
17950
17951@subsubheading Synopsis
17952
17953@smallexample
17954 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
17955@end smallexample
17956
17957Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
17958object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
17959for the object:
17960
17961@smallexample
17962 value=@var{value}
17963@end smallexample
17964
17965Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
17966before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
17967
17968@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
17969@findex -var-assign
17970
17971@subsubheading Synopsis
17972
17973@smallexample
17974 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
17975@end smallexample
17976
17977Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
17978by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
17979value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
17980subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
17981
17982@subsubheading Example
17983
17984@smallexample
17985(@value{GDBP})
17986-var-assign var1 3
17987^done,value="3"
17988(@value{GDBP})
17989-var-update *
17990^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
17991(@value{GDBP})
17992@end smallexample
17993
17994@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
17995@findex -var-update
17996
17997@subsubheading Synopsis
17998
17999@smallexample
18000 -var-update @{@var{name} | "*"@}
18001@end smallexample
18002
18003Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
18004expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
18005A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated.
18006
18007
18008@node Annotations
18009@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
18010
18011This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations are
18012designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or
18013other similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
18014relatively high level.
18015
18016@ignore
18017This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
18018@end ignore
18019
18020@menu
18021* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
18022* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
18023* Value Annotations:: Values are marked as such.
18024* Frame Annotations:: Stack frames are annotated.
18025* Displays:: @value{GDBN} can be told to display something periodically.
18026* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
18027* Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
18028* Breakpoint Info:: Information on breakpoints.
18029* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
18030* Annotations for Running::
18031 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
18032* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
18033* TODO:: Annotations which might be added in the future.
18034@end menu
18035
18036@node Annotations Overview
18037@section What is an Annotation?
18038@cindex annotations
18039
18040To produce annotations, start @value{GDBN} with the @code{--annotate=2} option.
18041
18042Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
18043characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
18044information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
18045is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
18046information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
18047additional information, and a newline. The additional information
18048cannot contain newline characters.
18049
18050Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
18051characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
18052no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
18053@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
18054annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
18055means those three characters as output.
18056
18057A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
18058
18059@smallexample
18060$ gdb --annotate=2
18061GNU GDB 5.0
18062Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
18063GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
18064and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
18065under certain conditions.
18066Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
18067There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
18068for details.
18069This GDB was configured as "sparc-sun-sunos4.1.3"
18070
18071^Z^Zpre-prompt
18072(gdb)
18073^Z^Zprompt
18074quit
18075
18076^Z^Zpost-prompt
18077$
18078@end smallexample
18079
18080Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
18081@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
18082denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
18083output from @value{GDBN}.
18084
18085@node Server Prefix
18086@section The Server Prefix
18087@cindex server prefix for annotations
18088
18089To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
18090the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
18091means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
18092affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
18093pressed on a line by itself.
18094
18095The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
18096history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
18097use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
18098
18099@node Value Annotations
18100@section Values
18101
18102@cindex annotations for values
18103When a value is printed in various contexts, @value{GDBN} uses
18104annotations to delimit the value from the surrounding text.
18105
18106@findex value-history-begin
18107@findex value-history-value
18108@findex value-history-end
18109If a value is printed using @code{print} and added to the value history,
18110the annotation looks like
18111
18112@smallexample
18113^Z^Zvalue-history-begin @var{history-number} @var{value-flags}
18114@var{history-string}
18115^Z^Zvalue-history-value
18116@var{the-value}
18117^Z^Zvalue-history-end
18118@end smallexample
18119
18120@noindent
18121where @var{history-number} is the number it is getting in the value
18122history, @var{history-string} is a string, such as @samp{$5 = }, which
18123introduces the value to the user, @var{the-value} is the output
18124corresponding to the value itself, and @var{value-flags} is @samp{*} for
18125a value which can be dereferenced and @samp{-} for a value which cannot.
18126
18127@findex value-begin
18128@findex value-end
18129If the value is not added to the value history (it is an invalid float
18130or it is printed with the @code{output} command), the annotation is similar:
18131
18132@smallexample
18133^Z^Zvalue-begin @var{value-flags}
18134@var{the-value}
18135^Z^Zvalue-end
18136@end smallexample
18137
18138@findex arg-begin
18139@findex arg-name-end
18140@findex arg-value
18141@findex arg-end
18142When @value{GDBN} prints an argument to a function (for example, in the output
18143from the @code{backtrace} command), it annotates it as follows:
18144
18145@smallexample
18146^Z^Zarg-begin
18147@var{argument-name}
18148^Z^Zarg-name-end
18149@var{separator-string}
18150^Z^Zarg-value @var{value-flags}
18151@var{the-value}
18152^Z^Zarg-end
18153@end smallexample
18154
18155@noindent
18156where @var{argument-name} is the name of the argument,
18157@var{separator-string} is text which separates the name from the value
18158for the user's benefit (such as @samp{=}), and @var{value-flags} and
18159@var{the-value} have the same meanings as in a
18160@code{value-history-begin} annotation.
18161
18162@findex field-begin
18163@findex field-name-end
18164@findex field-value
18165@findex field-end
18166When printing a structure, @value{GDBN} annotates it as follows:
18167
18168@smallexample
18169^Z^Zfield-begin @var{value-flags}
18170@var{field-name}
18171^Z^Zfield-name-end
18172@var{separator-string}
18173^Z^Zfield-value
18174@var{the-value}
18175^Z^Zfield-end
18176@end smallexample
18177
18178@noindent
18179where @var{field-name} is the name of the field, @var{separator-string}
18180is text which separates the name from the value for the user's benefit
18181(such as @samp{=}), and @var{value-flags} and @var{the-value} have the
18182same meanings as in a @code{value-history-begin} annotation.
18183
18184When printing an array, @value{GDBN} annotates it as follows:
18185
18186@smallexample
18187^Z^Zarray-section-begin @var{array-index} @var{value-flags}
18188@end smallexample
18189
18190@noindent
18191where @var{array-index} is the index of the first element being
18192annotated and @var{value-flags} has the same meaning as in a
18193@code{value-history-begin} annotation. This is followed by any number
18194of elements, where is element can be either a single element:
18195
18196@findex elt
18197@smallexample
18198@samp{,} @var{whitespace} ; @r{omitted for the first element}
18199@var{the-value}
18200^Z^Zelt
18201@end smallexample
18202
18203or a repeated element
18204
18205@findex elt-rep
18206@findex elt-rep-end
18207@smallexample
18208@samp{,} @var{whitespace} ; @r{omitted for the first element}
18209@var{the-value}
18210^Z^Zelt-rep @var{number-of-repetitions}
18211@var{repetition-string}
18212^Z^Zelt-rep-end
18213@end smallexample
18214
18215In both cases, @var{the-value} is the output for the value of the
18216element and @var{whitespace} can contain spaces, tabs, and newlines. In
18217the repeated case, @var{number-of-repetitions} is the number of
18218consecutive array elements which contain that value, and
18219@var{repetition-string} is a string which is designed to convey to the
18220user that repetition is being depicted.
18221
18222@findex array-section-end
18223Once all the array elements have been output, the array annotation is
18224ended with
18225
18226@smallexample
18227^Z^Zarray-section-end
18228@end smallexample
18229
18230@node Frame Annotations
18231@section Frames
18232
18233@cindex annotations for frames
18234Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a frame, it annotates it. For example, this applies
18235to frames printed when @value{GDBN} stops, output from commands such as
18236@code{backtrace} or @code{up}, etc.
18237
18238@findex frame-begin
18239The frame annotation begins with
18240
18241@smallexample
18242^Z^Zframe-begin @var{level} @var{address}
18243@var{level-string}
18244@end smallexample
18245
18246@noindent
18247where @var{level} is the number of the frame (0 is the innermost frame,
18248and other frames have positive numbers), @var{address} is the address of
18249the code executing in that frame, and @var{level-string} is a string
18250designed to convey the level to the user. @var{address} is in the form
18251@samp{0x} followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this
18252does not depend on the language). The frame ends with
18253
18254@findex frame-end
18255@smallexample
18256^Z^Zframe-end
18257@end smallexample
18258
18259Between these annotations is the main body of the frame, which can
18260consist of
18261
18262@itemize @bullet
18263@item
18264@findex function-call
18265@smallexample
18266^Z^Zfunction-call
18267@var{function-call-string}
18268@end smallexample
18269
18270where @var{function-call-string} is text designed to convey to the user
18271that this frame is associated with a function call made by @value{GDBN} to a
18272function in the program being debugged.
18273
18274@item
18275@findex signal-handler-caller
18276@smallexample
18277^Z^Zsignal-handler-caller
18278@var{signal-handler-caller-string}
18279@end smallexample
18280
18281where @var{signal-handler-caller-string} is text designed to convey to
18282the user that this frame is associated with whatever mechanism is used
18283by this operating system to call a signal handler (it is the frame which
18284calls the signal handler, not the frame for the signal handler itself).
18285
18286@item
18287A normal frame.
18288
18289@findex frame-address
18290@findex frame-address-end
18291This can optionally (depending on whether this is thought of as
18292interesting information for the user to see) begin with
18293
18294@smallexample
18295^Z^Zframe-address
18296@var{address}
18297^Z^Zframe-address-end
18298@var{separator-string}
18299@end smallexample
18300
18301where @var{address} is the address executing in the frame (the same
18302address as in the @code{frame-begin} annotation, but printed in a form
18303which is intended for user consumption---in particular, the syntax varies
18304depending on the language), and @var{separator-string} is a string
18305intended to separate this address from what follows for the user's
18306benefit.
18307
18308@findex frame-function-name
18309@findex frame-args
18310Then comes
18311
18312@smallexample
18313^Z^Zframe-function-name
18314@var{function-name}
18315^Z^Zframe-args
18316@var{arguments}
18317@end smallexample
18318
18319where @var{function-name} is the name of the function executing in the
18320frame, or @samp{??} if not known, and @var{arguments} are the arguments
18321to the frame, with parentheses around them (each argument is annotated
18322individually as well, @pxref{Value Annotations}).
18323
18324@findex frame-source-begin
18325@findex frame-source-file
18326@findex frame-source-file-end
18327@findex frame-source-line
18328@findex frame-source-end
18329If source information is available, a reference to it is then printed:
18330
18331@smallexample
18332^Z^Zframe-source-begin
18333@var{source-intro-string}
18334^Z^Zframe-source-file
18335@var{filename}
18336^Z^Zframe-source-file-end
18337:
18338^Z^Zframe-source-line
18339@var{line-number}
18340^Z^Zframe-source-end
18341@end smallexample
18342
18343where @var{source-intro-string} separates for the user's benefit the
18344reference from the text which precedes it, @var{filename} is the name of
18345the source file, and @var{line-number} is the line number within that
18346file (the first line is line 1).
18347
18348@findex frame-where
18349If @value{GDBN} prints some information about where the frame is from (which
18350library, which load segment, etc.; currently only done on the RS/6000),
18351it is annotated with
18352
18353@smallexample
18354^Z^Zframe-where
18355@var{information}
18356@end smallexample
18357
18358Then, if source is to actually be displayed for this frame (for example,
18359this is not true for output from the @code{backtrace} command), then a
18360@code{source} annotation (@pxref{Source Annotations}) is displayed. Unlike
18361most annotations, this is output instead of the normal text which would be
18362output, not in addition.
18363@end itemize
18364
18365@node Displays
18366@section Displays
18367
18368@findex display-begin
18369@findex display-number-end
18370@findex display-format
18371@findex display-expression
18372@findex display-expression-end
18373@findex display-value
18374@findex display-end
18375@cindex annotations for display
18376When @value{GDBN} is told to display something using the @code{display} command,
18377the results of the display are annotated:
18378
18379@smallexample
18380^Z^Zdisplay-begin
18381@var{number}
18382^Z^Zdisplay-number-end
18383@var{number-separator}
18384^Z^Zdisplay-format
18385@var{format}
18386^Z^Zdisplay-expression
18387@var{expression}
18388^Z^Zdisplay-expression-end
18389@var{expression-separator}
18390^Z^Zdisplay-value
18391@var{value}
18392^Z^Zdisplay-end
18393@end smallexample
18394
18395@noindent
18396where @var{number} is the number of the display, @var{number-separator}
18397is intended to separate the number from what follows for the user,
18398@var{format} includes information such as the size, format, or other
18399information about how the value is being displayed, @var{expression} is
18400the expression being displayed, @var{expression-separator} is intended
18401to separate the expression from the text that follows for the user,
18402and @var{value} is the actual value being displayed.
18403
18404@node Prompting
18405@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
18406
18407@cindex annotations for prompts
18408When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
18409to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
18410over, etc.
18411
18412Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
18413input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
18414denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
18415annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
18416annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
18417associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
18418features the following annotations:
18419
18420@smallexample
18421^Z^Zpre-prompt
18422^Z^Zprompt
18423^Z^Zpost-prompt
18424@end smallexample
18425
18426The input types are
18427
18428@table @code
18429@findex pre-prompt
18430@findex prompt
18431@findex post-prompt
18432@item prompt
18433When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
18434
18435@findex pre-commands
18436@findex commands
18437@findex post-commands
18438@item commands
18439When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
18440command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
18441
18442@findex pre-overload-choice
18443@findex overload-choice
18444@findex post-overload-choice
18445@item overload-choice
18446When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
18447
18448@findex pre-query
18449@findex query
18450@findex post-query
18451@item query
18452When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
18453
18454@findex pre-prompt-for-continue
18455@findex prompt-for-continue
18456@findex post-prompt-for-continue
18457@item prompt-for-continue
18458When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
18459expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
18460prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
18461presence of annotations.
18462@end table
18463
18464@node Errors
18465@section Errors
18466@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
18467
18468@findex quit
18469@smallexample
18470^Z^Zquit
18471@end smallexample
18472
18473This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
18474
18475@findex error
18476@smallexample
18477^Z^Zerror
18478@end smallexample
18479
18480This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
18481
18482Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
18483in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
18484@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
18485cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
18486cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
18487does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
18488to the top level.
18489
18490@findex error-begin
18491A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
18492
18493@smallexample
18494^Z^Zerror-begin
18495@end smallexample
18496
18497Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
18498message.
18499
18500Warning messages are not yet annotated.
18501@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
18502@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
18503
18504@node Breakpoint Info
18505@section Information on Breakpoints
18506
18507@cindex annotations for breakpoints
18508The output from the @code{info breakpoints} command is annotated as follows:
18509
18510@findex breakpoints-headers
18511@findex breakpoints-table
18512@smallexample
18513^Z^Zbreakpoints-headers
18514@var{header-entry}
18515^Z^Zbreakpoints-table
18516@end smallexample
18517
18518@noindent
18519where @var{header-entry} has the same syntax as an entry (see below) but
18520instead of containing data, it contains strings which are intended to
18521convey the meaning of each field to the user. This is followed by any
18522number of entries. If a field does not apply for this entry, it is
18523omitted. Fields may contain trailing whitespace. Each entry consists
18524of:
18525
18526@findex record
18527@findex field
18528@smallexample
18529^Z^Zrecord
18530^Z^Zfield 0
18531@var{number}
18532^Z^Zfield 1
18533@var{type}
18534^Z^Zfield 2
18535@var{disposition}
18536^Z^Zfield 3
18537@var{enable}
18538^Z^Zfield 4
18539@var{address}
18540^Z^Zfield 5
18541@var{what}
18542^Z^Zfield 6
18543@var{frame}
18544^Z^Zfield 7
18545@var{condition}
18546^Z^Zfield 8
18547@var{ignore-count}
18548^Z^Zfield 9
18549@var{commands}
18550@end smallexample
18551
18552Note that @var{address} is intended for user consumption---the syntax
18553varies depending on the language.
18554
18555The output ends with
18556
18557@findex breakpoints-table-end
18558@smallexample
18559^Z^Zbreakpoints-table-end
18560@end smallexample
18561
18562@node Invalidation
18563@section Invalidation Notices
18564
18565@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
18566The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
18567changed.
18568
18569@table @code
18570@findex frames-invalid
18571@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
18572
18573The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
18574have changed.
18575
18576@findex breakpoints-invalid
18577@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
18578
18579The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
18580deleted a breakpoint.
18581@end table
18582
18583@node Annotations for Running
18584@section Running the Program
18585@cindex annotations for running programs
18586
18587@findex starting
18588@findex stopping
18589When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
18590@code{step} or @code{continue},
18591
18592@smallexample
18593^Z^Zstarting
18594@end smallexample
18595
18596is output. When the program stops,
18597
18598@smallexample
18599^Z^Zstopped
18600@end smallexample
18601
18602is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
18603annotations describe how the program stopped.
18604
18605@table @code
18606@findex exited
18607@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
18608The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
18609successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
18610
18611@findex signalled
18612@findex signal-name
18613@findex signal-name-end
18614@findex signal-string
18615@findex signal-string-end
18616@item ^Z^Zsignalled
18617The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
18618annotation continues:
18619
18620@smallexample
18621@var{intro-text}
18622^Z^Zsignal-name
18623@var{name}
18624^Z^Zsignal-name-end
18625@var{middle-text}
18626^Z^Zsignal-string
18627@var{string}
18628^Z^Zsignal-string-end
18629@var{end-text}
18630@end smallexample
18631
18632@noindent
18633where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
18634@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
18635as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
18636@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
18637user's benefit and have no particular format.
18638
18639@findex signal
18640@item ^Z^Zsignal
18641The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
18642just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
18643terminated with it.
18644
18645@findex breakpoint
18646@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
18647The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
18648
18649@findex watchpoint
18650@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
18651The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
18652@end table
18653
18654@node Source Annotations
18655@section Displaying Source
18656@cindex annotations for source display
18657
18658@findex source
18659The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
18660
18661@smallexample
18662^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
18663@end smallexample
18664
18665where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
18666file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
18667first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
18668within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
18669debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
18670@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
18671line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
18672@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
18673source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
18674followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
18675depend on the language).
18676
18677@node TODO
18678@section Annotations We Might Want in the Future
18679
18680@format
18681 - target-invalid
18682 the target might have changed (registers, heap contents, or
18683 execution status). For performance, we might eventually want
18684 to hit `registers-invalid' and `all-registers-invalid' with
18685 greater precision
18686
18687 - systematic annotation for set/show parameters (including
18688 invalidation notices).
18689
18690 - similarly, `info' returns a list of candidates for invalidation
18691 notices.
18692@end format
c906108c 18693
8e04817f
AC
18694@node GDB Bugs
18695@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
18696@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
18697@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 18698
8e04817f 18699Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 18700
8e04817f
AC
18701Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
18702may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
18703the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
18704reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 18705
8e04817f
AC
18706In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
18707information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
18708
18709@menu
8e04817f
AC
18710* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
18711* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
18712@end menu
18713
8e04817f
AC
18714@node Bug Criteria
18715@section Have you found a bug?
18716@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 18717
8e04817f 18718If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
18719
18720@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
18721@cindex fatal signal
18722@cindex debugger crash
18723@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 18724@item
8e04817f
AC
18725If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
18726@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
18727
18728@cindex error on valid input
18729@item
18730If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
18731bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
18732somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 18733
8e04817f 18734@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 18735@item
8e04817f
AC
18736If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
18737that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
18738``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
18739for traditional practice''.
18740
18741@item
18742If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
18743for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
18744@end itemize
18745
8e04817f
AC
18746@node Bug Reporting
18747@section How to report bugs
18748@cindex bug reports
18749@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
18750
18751A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
18752If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
18753contact that organization first.
18754
18755You can find contact information for many support companies and
18756individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
18757distribution.
18758@c should add a web page ref...
18759
129188f6
AC
18760In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
18761@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
18762@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
18763page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
18764be used.
8e04817f
AC
18765
18766@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
18767@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
18768not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
18769@samp{bug-gdb}.
18770
18771The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
18772serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
18773the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
18774newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
18775problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
18776path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
18777we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
18778bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 18779
8e04817f
AC
18780The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
18781@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
18782fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 18783
8e04817f
AC
18784Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
18785problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
18786assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
18787Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
18788stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
18789name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
18790of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
18791the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
18792easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 18793
8e04817f
AC
18794Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
18795bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
18796you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
18797self-contained.
c4555f82 18798
8e04817f
AC
18799Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
18800bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
18801@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
18802bugs properly.
18803
18804To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
18805
18806@itemize @bullet
18807@item
8e04817f
AC
18808The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
18809with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
18810version}.
c4555f82 18811
8e04817f
AC
18812Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
18813the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
18814
18815@item
8e04817f
AC
18816The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
18817version number.
c4555f82
SC
18818
18819@item
8e04817f
AC
18820What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
18821``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
18822
18823@item
8e04817f
AC
18824What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
18825debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
18826C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
18827information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
18828compilers.
c4555f82 18829
8e04817f
AC
18830@item
18831The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
18832observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
18833you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
18834Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 18835
8e04817f
AC
18836If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
18837and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 18838
8e04817f
AC
18839@item
18840A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
18841reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 18842
8e04817f
AC
18843@item
18844A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
18845incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 18846
8e04817f
AC
18847Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
18848will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
18849not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
18850a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 18851
8e04817f
AC
18852Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
18853say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
18854copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
18855the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
18856crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
18857ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
18858us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
18859to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 18860
8e04817f
AC
18861@item
18862If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
18863diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
18864it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 18865
8e04817f
AC
18866The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
18867sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 18868
8e04817f 18869@end itemize
c4555f82 18870
8e04817f 18871Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 18872
8e04817f
AC
18873@itemize @bullet
18874@item
18875A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 18876
8e04817f
AC
18877Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
18878which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
18879changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 18880
8e04817f
AC
18881This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
18882will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
18883with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
18884We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 18885
8e04817f
AC
18886Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
18887of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
18888output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
18889less time, and so on.
c4555f82 18890
8e04817f
AC
18891However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
18892report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 18893
8e04817f
AC
18894@item
18895A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 18896
8e04817f
AC
18897A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
18898the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
18899a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
18900to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 18901
8e04817f
AC
18902Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
18903construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
18904through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
18905to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 18906
8e04817f
AC
18907And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
18908patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
18909help us to understand.
c4555f82 18910
8e04817f
AC
18911@item
18912A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 18913
8e04817f
AC
18914Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
18915things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
18916@end itemize
c4555f82 18917
8e04817f
AC
18918@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
18919@c and consists of the two following files:
18920@c rluser.texinfo
18921@c inc-hist.texinfo
18922@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
18923@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
18924@include rluser.texinfo
18925@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 18926
c4555f82 18927
8e04817f
AC
18928@node Formatting Documentation
18929@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 18930
8e04817f
AC
18931@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
18932@cindex reference card
18933The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
18934for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
18935subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
18936@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
18937release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
18938you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 18939
8e04817f
AC
18940The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
18941can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 18942
474c8240 18943@smallexample
8e04817f 18944make refcard.dvi
474c8240 18945@end smallexample
c4555f82 18946
8e04817f
AC
18947The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
18948mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
18949that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
18950high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
18951your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 18952
8e04817f 18953@cindex documentation
c4555f82 18954
8e04817f
AC
18955All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
18956distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
18957a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
18958on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
18959formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
18960and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 18961
8e04817f
AC
18962@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
18963version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
18964file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
18965subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
18966necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
18967but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
18968Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
18969@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 18970
8e04817f
AC
18971If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
18972Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
18973@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 18974
8e04817f
AC
18975If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
18976@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
18977version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 18978
474c8240 18979@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
18980cd gdb
18981make gdb.info
474c8240 18982@end smallexample
c4555f82 18983
8e04817f
AC
18984If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
18985a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
18986Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 18987
8e04817f
AC
18988@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
18989produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
18990document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
18991has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
18992command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
18993(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
18994require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 18995
8e04817f
AC
18996@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
18997@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
18998written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
18999typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
19000and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
19001directory.
c4555f82 19002
8e04817f
AC
19003If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
19004typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
19005subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
19006@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 19007
474c8240 19008@smallexample
8e04817f 19009make gdb.dvi
474c8240 19010@end smallexample
c4555f82 19011
8e04817f 19012Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 19013
8e04817f
AC
19014@node Installing GDB
19015@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
19016@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
19017@cindex installation
94e91d6d 19018@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
c4555f82 19019
8e04817f
AC
19020@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
19021of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
19022build the @code{gdb} program.
19023@iftex
19024@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
19025@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
19026look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
19027installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
19028@end iftex
c4555f82 19029
8e04817f
AC
19030The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
19031@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
19032appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 19033
8e04817f
AC
19034For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
19035@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 19036
8e04817f
AC
19037@table @code
19038@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
19039script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 19040
8e04817f
AC
19041@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
19042the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 19043
8e04817f
AC
19044@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
19045source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 19046
8e04817f
AC
19047@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
19048@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 19049
8e04817f
AC
19050@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
19051source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 19052
8e04817f
AC
19053@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
19054source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 19055
8e04817f
AC
19056@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
19057source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 19058
8e04817f
AC
19059@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
19060source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 19061
8e04817f
AC
19062@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
19063source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
19064@end table
c906108c 19065
8e04817f
AC
19066The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
19067from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
19068this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 19069
8e04817f
AC
19070First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
19071if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
19072identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
19073argument.
c906108c 19074
8e04817f 19075For example:
c906108c 19076
474c8240 19077@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19078cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
19079./configure @var{host}
19080make
474c8240 19081@end smallexample
c906108c 19082
8e04817f
AC
19083@noindent
19084where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
19085@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
19086(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
19087correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 19088
8e04817f
AC
19089Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
19090@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
19091libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
19092binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 19093
8e04817f
AC
19094@need 750
19095@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
19096system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
19097shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 19098
474c8240 19099@smallexample
8e04817f 19100sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 19101@end smallexample
c906108c 19102
8e04817f
AC
19103If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
19104directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
19105@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
19106creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
19107you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
19108
94e91d6d
MC
19109You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
19110source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
19111@code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
19112that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
19113if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
19114of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
19115configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
19116directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
19117about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
c906108c 19118
8e04817f
AC
19119You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
19120However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
19121the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
19122that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
19123let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 19124
8e04817f
AC
19125@menu
19126* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
19127* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
19128* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
19129@end menu
c906108c 19130
8e04817f
AC
19131@node Separate Objdir
19132@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 19133
8e04817f
AC
19134If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
19135you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
19136host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
19137allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
19138rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
19139handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
19140@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
19141program specified there.
c906108c 19142
8e04817f
AC
19143To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
19144with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
19145(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
19146itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
19147would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
19148the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 19149
8e04817f
AC
19150For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
19151separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 19152
474c8240 19153@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19154@group
19155cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
19156mkdir ../gdb-sun4
19157cd ../gdb-sun4
19158../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
19159make
19160@end group
474c8240 19161@end smallexample
c906108c 19162
8e04817f
AC
19163When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
19164directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
19165(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
19166the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
19167directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
19168@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 19169
94e91d6d
MC
19170Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
19171instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
19172like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
19173one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
19174build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
19175
8e04817f
AC
19176One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
19177directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
19178@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
19179programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
19180You specify a cross-debugging target by
19181giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 19182
8e04817f
AC
19183When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
19184it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
19185called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 19186
8e04817f
AC
19187The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
19188directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
19189directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
19190directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
19191will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 19192
8e04817f
AC
19193When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
19194directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
19195if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
19196with each other.
c906108c 19197
8e04817f
AC
19198@node Config Names
19199@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 19200
8e04817f
AC
19201The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
19202script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
19203aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
19204of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 19205
474c8240 19206@smallexample
8e04817f 19207@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 19208@end smallexample
c906108c 19209
8e04817f
AC
19210For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
19211or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
19212option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 19213
8e04817f
AC
19214The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
19215any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
19216aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
19217@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
19218script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
19219abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 19220
8e04817f
AC
19221@smallexample
19222% sh config.sub i386-linux
19223i386-pc-linux-gnu
19224% sh config.sub alpha-linux
19225alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
19226% sh config.sub hp9k700
19227hppa1.1-hp-hpux
19228% sh config.sub sun4
19229sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
19230% sh config.sub sun3
19231m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
19232% sh config.sub i986v
19233Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
19234@end smallexample
c906108c 19235
8e04817f
AC
19236@noindent
19237@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
19238directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 19239
8e04817f
AC
19240@node Configure Options
19241@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 19242
8e04817f
AC
19243Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
19244are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
19245several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
19246Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 19247
474c8240 19248@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19249configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
19250 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19251 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19252 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
19253 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
19254 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
19255 @var{host}
474c8240 19256@end smallexample
c906108c 19257
8e04817f
AC
19258@noindent
19259You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
19260@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
19261@samp{--}.
c906108c 19262
8e04817f
AC
19263@table @code
19264@item --help
19265Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 19266
8e04817f
AC
19267@item --prefix=@var{dir}
19268Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
19269@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 19270
8e04817f
AC
19271@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
19272Configure the source to install programs under directory
19273@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 19274
8e04817f
AC
19275@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
19276@need 2000
19277@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
19278@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
19279@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
19280Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
19281@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
19282build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
19283directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
19284the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
19285directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
19286the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
19287@var{dirname}.
c906108c 19288
8e04817f
AC
19289@item --norecursion
19290Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
19291propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 19292
8e04817f
AC
19293@item --target=@var{target}
19294Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
19295@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
19296programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 19297
8e04817f 19298There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 19299
8e04817f
AC
19300@item @var{host} @dots{}
19301Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 19302
8e04817f
AC
19303There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
19304@end table
c906108c 19305
8e04817f
AC
19306There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
19307needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 19308
8e04817f
AC
19309@node Maintenance Commands
19310@appendix Maintenance Commands
19311@cindex maintenance commands
19312@cindex internal commands
c906108c 19313
8e04817f
AC
19314In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
19315includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
19316These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 19317
8e04817f
AC
19318@table @code
19319@kindex maint info breakpoints
19320@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
19321Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
19322breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
19323internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
19324breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
19325is shown:
c906108c 19326
8e04817f
AC
19327@table @code
19328@item breakpoint
19329Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 19330
8e04817f
AC
19331@item watchpoint
19332Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 19333
8e04817f
AC
19334@item longjmp
19335Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
19336@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 19337
8e04817f
AC
19338@item longjmp resume
19339Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 19340
8e04817f
AC
19341@item until
19342Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 19343
8e04817f
AC
19344@item finish
19345Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 19346
8e04817f
AC
19347@item shlib events
19348Shared library events.
c906108c 19349
8e04817f 19350@end table
c906108c 19351
8d30a00d
AC
19352@kindex maint internal-error
19353@kindex maint internal-warning
19354@item maint internal-error
19355@itemx maint internal-warning
19356Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
19357or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
19358or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
19359internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
19360either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
19361@value{GDBN} session.
19362
19363@smallexample
19364(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
19365@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
19366A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
19367debugging may prove unreliable.
19368Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19369Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19370(gdb)
19371@end smallexample
19372
19373Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
19374warning message.
19375
00905d52
AC
19376@kindex maint print dummy-frames
19377@item maint print dummy-frames
19378
19379Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
19380
19381@smallexample
19382(gdb) @kbd{b add}
19383@dots{}
19384(gdb) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
19385Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
1938658 return (a + b);
19387The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
19388@dots{}
19389(gdb) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
193900x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
19391 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
19392 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
19393(gdb)
19394@end smallexample
19395
19396Takes an optional file parameter.
19397
0680b120
AC
19398@kindex maint print registers
19399@kindex maint print raw-registers
19400@kindex maint print cooked-registers
617073a9 19401@kindex maint print register-groups
0680b120
AC
19402@item maint print registers
19403@itemx maint print raw-registers
19404@itemx maint print cooked-registers
617073a9 19405@itemx maint print register-groups
0680b120
AC
19406Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
19407
617073a9
AC
19408The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
19409the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
19410includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
19411@code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
19412register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
19413@value{GDBN} Internals}.
0680b120
AC
19414
19415Takes an optional file parameter.
19416
617073a9
AC
19417@kindex maint print reggroups
19418@item maint print reggroups
19419Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.
19420
19421Takes an optional file parameter.
19422
19423@smallexample
19424(gdb) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
19425 Group Type
19426 general user
19427 float user
19428 all user
19429 vector user
19430 system user
19431 save internal
19432 restore internal
19433@end smallexample
19434
e7ba9c65
DJ
19435@kindex maint set profile
19436@kindex maint show profile
19437@cindex profiling GDB
19438@item maint set profile
19439@itemx maint show profile
19440Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
19441
19442Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
19443command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
19444collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
19445exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
19446if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
19447(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
19448data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
19449
19450Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
19451compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
19452
8e04817f 19453@end table
c906108c 19454
c906108c 19455
e0ce93ac 19456@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 19457@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 19458
ee2d5c50
AC
19459@menu
19460* Overview::
19461* Packets::
19462* Stop Reply Packets::
19463* General Query Packets::
19464* Register Packet Format::
19465* Examples::
0ce1b118 19466* File-I/O remote protocol extension::
ee2d5c50
AC
19467@end menu
19468
19469@node Overview
19470@section Overview
19471
8e04817f
AC
19472There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
19473protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
19474machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
19475recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 19476
d2c6833e 19477In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 19478transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 19479
8e04817f
AC
19480@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
19481@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
19482@cindex remote serial protocol
19483All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
19484sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
19485@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
19486@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 19487
474c8240 19488@smallexample
8e04817f 19489@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 19490@end smallexample
8e04817f 19491@noindent
c906108c 19492
8e04817f
AC
19493@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
19494@noindent
19495The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
19496characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
19497eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 19498
8e04817f
AC
19499Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
19500specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 19501
474c8240 19502@smallexample
8e04817f 19503@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 19504@end smallexample
c906108c 19505
8e04817f
AC
19506@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
19507@noindent
19508That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
19509has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
19510since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 19511
8e04817f
AC
19512@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
19513When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
19514response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
19515the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
19516retransmission):
c906108c 19517
474c8240 19518@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
19519-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19520<- @code{+}
474c8240 19521@end smallexample
8e04817f 19522@noindent
53a5351d 19523
8e04817f
AC
19524The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
19525debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
19526the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
19527when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 19528
8e04817f
AC
19529@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
19530exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
19531exceptions).
c906108c 19532
8e04817f 19533Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 19534@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 19535@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 19536@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 19537
8e04817f
AC
19538Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
19539@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
19540would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 19541
8e04817f
AC
19542Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
19543means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
19544which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
19545@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
19546where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
19547characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
19548value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 19549
8e04817f
AC
19550Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
19551loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
19552character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 19553
8e04817f 19554So:
474c8240 19555@smallexample
8e04817f 19556"@code{0* }"
474c8240 19557@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
19558@noindent
19559means the same as "0000".
c906108c 19560
8e04817f
AC
19561The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
19562error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 19563
8e04817f
AC
19564For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
19565(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
19566protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
19567on that response.
c906108c 19568
8e04817f
AC
19569A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
19570@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
19571optional.
c906108c 19572
ee2d5c50
AC
19573@node Packets
19574@section Packets
19575
19576The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
19577@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
19578
19579@table @r
19580
19581@item @code{!} --- extended mode
19582@cindex @code{!} packet
19583
8e04817f
AC
19584Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
19585persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
19586debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
19587
19588Reply:
19589@table @samp
19590@item OK
8e04817f 19591The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 19592@end table
c906108c 19593
ee2d5c50
AC
19594@item @code{?} --- last signal
19595@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 19596
ee2d5c50
AC
19597Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
19598step and continue.
c906108c 19599
ee2d5c50
AC
19600Reply:
19601@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19602
19603@item @code{a} --- reserved
19604
19605Reserved for future use.
19606
19607@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
19608@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 19609
8e04817f
AC
19610Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
19611specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
19612See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
19613
19614Reply:
19615@table @samp
19616@item OK
19617@item E@var{NN}
19618@end table
19619
19620@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
19621@cindex @code{b} packet
19622
19623Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
19624
19625JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
19626received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
19627problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
19628
19629Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
19630it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
19631some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
19632switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
19633of view, nothing actually happened.}
19634
19635@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
19636@cindex @code{B} packet
19637
8e04817f 19638Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
19639breakpoint at @var{addr}.
19640
19641This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
19642(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 19643
ee2d5c50
AC
19644@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
19645@cindex @code{c} packet
19646
19647@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 19648current address.
c906108c 19649
ee2d5c50
AC
19650Reply:
19651@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19652
19653@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
19654@cindex @code{C} packet
19655
8e04817f
AC
19656Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
19657@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 19658
ee2d5c50
AC
19659Reply:
19660@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 19661
ee2d5c50
AC
19662@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
19663@cindex @code{d} packet
19664
19665Toggle debug flag.
19666
19667@item @code{D} --- detach
19668@cindex @code{D} packet
19669
19670Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
19671before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
19672
19673Reply:
19674@table @samp
19675@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 19676@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 19677@end table
c906108c 19678
ee2d5c50 19679@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 19680
ee2d5c50 19681Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19682
ee2d5c50 19683@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 19684
ee2d5c50 19685Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19686
ee2d5c50
AC
19687@item @code{f} --- reserved
19688
19689Reserved for future use.
19690
0ce1b118
CV
19691@item @code{F}@var{RC}@code{,}@var{EE}@code{,}@var{CF}@code{;}@var{XX} --- Reply to target's F packet.
19692@cindex @code{F} packet
ee2d5c50 19693
0ce1b118
CV
19694This packet is send by @value{GDBN} as reply to a @code{F} request packet
19695sent by the target. This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension.
19696@xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
ee2d5c50
AC
19697
19698@item @code{g} --- read registers
19699@anchor{read registers packet}
19700@cindex @code{g} packet
19701
19702Read general registers.
19703
19704Reply:
19705@table @samp
19706@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
19707Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
19708with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
19709each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
ee2d5c50
AC
19710determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
19711and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8e04817f 19712@code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
19713@item E@var{NN}
19714for an error.
19715@end table
c906108c 19716
ee2d5c50
AC
19717@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
19718@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 19719
ee2d5c50
AC
19720@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
19721data.
19722
19723Reply:
19724@table @samp
19725@item OK
19726for success
19727@item E@var{NN}
19728for an error
19729@end table
19730
19731@item @code{h} --- reserved
19732
19733Reserved for future use.
19734
19735@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
19736@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 19737
8e04817f 19738Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
19739@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
19740should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
19741operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
19742the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
19743
19744Reply:
19745@table @samp
19746@item OK
19747for success
19748@item E@var{NN}
19749for an error
19750@end table
c906108c 19751
8e04817f
AC
19752@c FIXME: JTC:
19753@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
19754@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
19755@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
19756@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
19757@c described. For example:
19758@c
19759@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19760@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
19761@c otherwise returns current registers.
19762@c
19763@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19764@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
19765@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 19766
ee2d5c50
AC
19767@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
19768@anchor{cycle step packet}
19769@cindex @code{i} packet
19770
8e04817f
AC
19771Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
19772present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
19773step starting at that address.
c906108c 19774
ee2d5c50
AC
19775@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
19776@cindex @code{I} packet
19777
19778@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
19779
19780@item @code{j} --- reserved
19781
19782Reserved for future use.
19783
19784@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 19785
ee2d5c50 19786Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19787
ee2d5c50
AC
19788@item @code{k} --- kill request
19789@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 19790
ac282366 19791FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
19792thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
19793thread?)}.
c906108c 19794
ee2d5c50 19795@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 19796
ee2d5c50
AC
19797Reserved for future use.
19798
19799@item @code{l} --- reserved
19800
19801Reserved for future use.
19802
19803@item @code{L} --- reserved
19804
19805Reserved for future use.
19806
19807@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
19808@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 19809
8e04817f 19810Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50 19811Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
2e834e49 19812assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 19813transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 19814
ee2d5c50
AC
19815Reply:
19816@table @samp
19817@item @var{XX@dots{}}
19818@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
19819to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
2e834e49 19820that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
ee2d5c50
AC
19821accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
19822needed.}
19823@item E@var{NN}
19824@var{NN} is errno
19825@end table
19826
19827@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
19828@cindex @code{M} packet
19829
8e04817f 19830Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
19831@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
19832
19833Reply:
19834@table @samp
19835@item OK
19836for success
19837@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
19838for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
19839written).
ee2d5c50 19840@end table
c906108c 19841
ee2d5c50 19842@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 19843
ee2d5c50 19844Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19845
ee2d5c50 19846@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 19847
ee2d5c50 19848Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19849
ee2d5c50
AC
19850@item @code{o} --- reserved
19851
19852Reserved for future use.
19853
19854@item @code{O} --- reserved
19855
19856Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19857
ee2d5c50
AC
19858@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
19859@cindex @code{p} packet
19860
19861@xref{write register packet}.
19862
19863Reply:
19864@table @samp
19865@item @var{r@dots{}.}
19866The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
19867@end table
19868
19869@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
19870@anchor{write register packet}
19871@cindex @code{P} packet
19872
19873Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 19874digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 19875
ee2d5c50
AC
19876Reply:
19877@table @samp
19878@item OK
19879for success
19880@item E@var{NN}
19881for an error
19882@end table
19883
19884@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
19885@anchor{general query packet}
19886@cindex @code{q} packet
19887
19888Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
19889leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
19890prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
19891be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
19892that they match the full @var{query} name.
19893
19894Reply:
19895@table @samp
19896@item @var{XX@dots{}}
19897Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
19898@item E@var{NN}
19899error reply
8e04817f 19900@item
ee2d5c50
AC
19901Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
19902@end table
19903
19904@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
19905@cindex @code{Q} packet
19906
19907Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
19908
19909@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 19910
ee2d5c50
AC
19911@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
19912@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 19913
8e04817f 19914Reset the entire system.
c906108c 19915
ee2d5c50
AC
19916@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
19917@cindex @code{R} packet
19918
8e04817f
AC
19919Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
19920This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
19921
19922Reply:
19923@table @samp
19924@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 19925The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
19926@end table
19927
19928@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
19929@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 19930
8e04817f
AC
19931@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
19932same address.
c906108c 19933
ee2d5c50
AC
19934Reply:
19935@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19936
19937@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
19938@anchor{step with signal packet}
19939@cindex @code{S} packet
19940
8e04817f 19941Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 19942
ee2d5c50
AC
19943Reply:
19944@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19945
19946@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
19947@cindex @code{t} packet
19948
8e04817f 19949Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
19950@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
19951@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 19952
ee2d5c50
AC
19953@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
19954@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 19955
ee2d5c50 19956Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 19957
ee2d5c50
AC
19958Reply:
19959@table @samp
19960@item OK
19961thread is still alive
19962@item E@var{NN}
19963thread is dead
19964@end table
19965
19966@item @code{u} --- reserved
19967
19968Reserved for future use.
19969
19970@item @code{U} --- reserved
19971
19972Reserved for future use.
19973
19974@item @code{v} --- reserved
19975
19976Reserved for future use.
19977
19978@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 19979
ee2d5c50 19980Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19981
ee2d5c50 19982@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 19983
ee2d5c50 19984Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19985
ee2d5c50 19986@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 19987
ee2d5c50 19988Reserved for future use.
c906108c 19989
ee2d5c50
AC
19990@item @code{x} --- reserved
19991
19992Reserved for future use.
19993
19994@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
19995@cindex @code{X} packet
19996
19997@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
19998is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 19999escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 20000
ee2d5c50
AC
20001Reply:
20002@table @samp
20003@item OK
20004for success
20005@item E@var{NN}
20006for an error
20007@end table
20008
20009@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 20010
ee2d5c50 20011Reserved for future use.
c906108c 20012
ee2d5c50
AC
20013@item @code{Y} reserved
20014
20015Reserved for future use.
20016
2f870471
AC
20017@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20018@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20019@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 20020@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 20021@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 20022
2f870471
AC
20023Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
20024watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
20025@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 20026
2f870471
AC
20027Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
20028separately.
20029
512217c7
AC
20030@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
20031for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
20032remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
2f870471
AC
20033@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
20034avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
20035be implemented in an idempotent way.}
20036
20037@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20038@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20039@cindex @code{z0} packet
20040@cindex @code{Z0} packet
20041
20042Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
20043@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
20044
20045A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
20046@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
20047@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
20048breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
20049@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 20050
2f870471
AC
20051@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
20052code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
20053overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
20054target, is not defined.}
c906108c 20055
ee2d5c50
AC
20056Reply:
20057@table @samp
2f870471
AC
20058@item OK
20059success
20060@item
20061not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
20062@item E@var{NN}
20063for an error
2f870471
AC
20064@end table
20065
20066@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20067@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20068@cindex @code{z1} packet
20069@cindex @code{Z1} packet
20070
20071Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
20072address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
20073
20074A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
20075dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
20076
20077@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
20078movement.}
20079
20080Reply:
20081@table @samp
ee2d5c50 20082@item OK
2f870471
AC
20083success
20084@item
20085not supported
20086@item E@var{NN}
20087for an error
20088@end table
20089
20090@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20091@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20092@cindex @code{z2} packet
20093@cindex @code{Z2} packet
20094
20095Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
20096
20097Reply:
20098@table @samp
20099@item OK
20100success
20101@item
20102not supported
20103@item E@var{NN}
20104for an error
20105@end table
20106
20107@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20108@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20109@cindex @code{z3} packet
20110@cindex @code{Z3} packet
20111
2e834e49 20112Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
2f870471
AC
20113
20114Reply:
20115@table @samp
20116@item OK
20117success
20118@item
20119not supported
20120@item E@var{NN}
20121for an error
20122@end table
20123
2e834e49
HPN
20124@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20125@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
2f870471
AC
20126@cindex @code{z4} packet
20127@cindex @code{Z4} packet
20128
20129Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
20130
20131Reply:
20132@table @samp
20133@item OK
20134success
20135@item
20136not supported
20137@item E@var{NN}
20138for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
20139@end table
20140
20141@end table
c906108c 20142
ee2d5c50
AC
20143@node Stop Reply Packets
20144@section Stop Reply Packets
20145@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 20146
8e04817f
AC
20147The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
20148receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
20149@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
20150when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
20151number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
20152conventions is used.
c906108c 20153
ee2d5c50 20154@table @samp
c906108c 20155
ee2d5c50
AC
20156@item S@var{AA}
20157@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 20158
8e04817f 20159@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
20160@cindex @code{T} packet reply
20161
8e04817f
AC
20162@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
20163(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
20164by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
20165thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
20166@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
20167integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
20168@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
20169to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 20170
ee2d5c50
AC
20171@item W@var{AA}
20172
8e04817f 20173The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
20174applicable to certain targets.
20175
20176@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 20177
8e04817f 20178The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 20179
ee2d5c50
AC
20180@item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
20181
20182@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
20183@code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
20184base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
20185The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
20186the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
20187is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
c906108c 20188
ee2d5c50 20189@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 20190
ee2d5c50
AC
20191@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
20192any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
20193to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
20194
0ce1b118
CV
20195@item F@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20196
20197@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
20198be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
20199correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
20200@xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
20201system calls.
20202
20203@var{parameter@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for this very
20204system call.
20205
20206The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to call
20207a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies with
20208an appropriate @code{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next reply
20209packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or
20210@samp{s} action is expected to be continued.
20211@xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for more details.
20212
ee2d5c50
AC
20213@end table
20214
20215@node General Query Packets
20216@section General Query Packets
c906108c 20217
8e04817f 20218The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 20219
ee2d5c50 20220@table @r
c906108c 20221
ee2d5c50
AC
20222@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
20223
20224Return the current thread id.
20225
20226Reply:
20227@table @samp
20228@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 20229Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
20230@item *
20231Any other reply implies the old pid.
20232@end table
20233
20234@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
20235
20236@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 20237
8e04817f
AC
20238Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
20239may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
20240works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
20241obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
20242be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
20243sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
20244
20245NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
20246
20247Reply:
20248@table @samp
20249@item @code{m}@var{id}
20250A single thread id
20251@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
20252a comma-separated list of thread ids
20253@item @code{l}
20254(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
20255@end table
20256
20257In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
20258more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
20259will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
20260@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
20261(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 20262
ee2d5c50
AC
20263@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
20264
20265Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
20266string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
20267string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
20268@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
20269in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
20270possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
20271Mutex''.
20272
20273Reply:
20274@table @samp
20275@item @var{XX@dots{}}
20276Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
20277the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 20278attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
20279@end table
20280
20281@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 20282
8e04817f
AC
20283Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
20284digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
20285subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
20286number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
20287(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
20288returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
20289
20290NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
20291(see above).
20292
20293Reply:
20294@table @samp
20295@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
20296Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
20297returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
20298and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
20299digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
20300is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 20301digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 20302@end table
c906108c 20303
ee2d5c50
AC
20304@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
20305
20306Reply:
20307@table @samp
20308@item @code{E}@var{NN}
20309An error (such as memory fault)
20310@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
20311A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
20312@end table
20313
20314@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 20315
8e04817f
AC
20316Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
20317image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
20318response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
20319offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 20320
ee2d5c50
AC
20321Reply:
20322@table @samp
20323@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
20324@end table
20325
20326@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
20327
8e04817f
AC
20328Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
20329encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
20330
20331Reply:
20332@table @samp
20333@item *
20334@end table
20335
8e04817f 20336See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 20337
ee2d5c50
AC
20338@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
20339
20340@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
20341execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
20342Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
20343number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
20344@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
20345interpreter may have security implications}.
20346
20347Reply:
20348@table @samp
20349@item OK
8e04817f 20350A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 20351@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 20352A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 20353@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 20354Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 20355@item @samp{}
8e04817f 20356When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
20357@end table
20358
20359@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 20360
8e04817f
AC
20361Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
20362requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
20363
20364Reply:
20365@table @samp
20366@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 20367The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
20368@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20369The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
20370@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
20371@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
20372@end table
20373
20374@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
20375
20376Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
20377
20378@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
20379target has previously requested.
20380
20381@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
20382@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
20383will be empty.
20384
20385Reply:
20386@table @samp
20387@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 20388The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
20389@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20390The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
20391encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
20392(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
20393@end table
eb12ee30 20394
ee2d5c50
AC
20395@end table
20396
20397@node Register Packet Format
20398@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 20399
8e04817f 20400The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
20401In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
20402sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
20403to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
20404byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
20405most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 20406
ee2d5c50 20407@table @r
eb12ee30 20408
8e04817f 20409@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 20410
8e04817f
AC
20411All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
2041232 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
20413registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 20414
8e04817f 20415@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 20416
8e04817f
AC
20417All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
20418thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
20419as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 20420
ee2d5c50
AC
20421@end table
20422
20423@node Examples
20424@section Examples
eb12ee30 20425
8e04817f
AC
20426Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
20427does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 20428
474c8240 20429@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
20430-> @code{R00}
20431<- @code{+}
8e04817f 20432@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 20433-> @code{?}
8e04817f 20434<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
20435<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20436-> @code{+}
474c8240 20437@end smallexample
eb12ee30 20438
8e04817f 20439Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 20440
474c8240 20441@smallexample
d2c6833e 20442-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 20443<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
20444-> @code{s}
20445<- @code{+}
20446@emph{time passes}
20447<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 20448-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 20449-> @code{g}
8e04817f 20450<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
20451<- @code{1455@dots{}}
20452-> @code{+}
474c8240 20453@end smallexample
eb12ee30 20454
0ce1b118
CV
20455@node File-I/O remote protocol extension
20456@section File-I/O remote protocol extension
20457@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
20458
20459@menu
20460* File-I/O Overview::
20461* Protocol basics::
20462* The `F' request packet::
20463* The `F' reply packet::
20464* Memory transfer::
20465* The Ctrl-C message::
20466* Console I/O::
20467* The isatty call::
20468* The system call::
20469* List of supported calls::
20470* Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
20471* Constants::
20472* File-I/O Examples::
20473@end menu
20474
20475@node File-I/O Overview
20476@subsection File-I/O Overview
20477@cindex file-i/o overview
20478
20479The File I/O remote protocol extension (short: File-I/O) allows the
20480target to use the hosts file system and console I/O when calling various
20481system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
20482remote protocol packet to the host system which then performs the needed
20483actions and returns with an adequate response packet to the target system.
20484This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
20485
20486The protocol is defined host- and target-system independent. It uses
20487it's own independent representation of datatypes and values. Both,
20488@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
20489translating the system dependent values into the unified protocol values
20490when data is transmitted.
20491
20492The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only
20493when GDB is waiting for the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s}
20494packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
20495the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
20496memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interuptible by target signals. It
20497is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt (Ctrl-C), though.
20498
20499The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
20500the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
20501after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
20502previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
20503request from @value{GDBN} is required.
20504
20505@smallexample
20506(gdb) continue
20507 <- target requests 'system call X'
20508 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
20509 -> GDB returns result
20510 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
20511 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
20512@end smallexample
20513
20514The protocol is only used for files on the host file system and
20515for I/O on the console. Character or block special devices, pipes,
20516named pipes or sockets or any other communication method on the host
20517system are not supported by this protocol.
20518
20519@node Protocol basics
20520@subsection Protocol basics
20521@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
20522
20523The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet, as request as well
20524as as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
20525@value{GDBN} is waiting for the continuing or stepping target, the
20526File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
20527of a former @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
20528This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
20529to call the appropriate host system call:
20530
20531@itemize @bullet
20532@item
20533A unique identifier for the requested system call.
20534
20535@item
20536All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
20537in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
20538pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
20539Numerical control values are given in a protocol specific representation.
20540
20541@end itemize
20542
20543At that point @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
20544
20545@itemize @bullet
20546@item
20547If parameter pointer values are given, which point to data needed as input
20548to a system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
20549standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
20550expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
20551packet.
20552
20553@item
20554@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
20555representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
20556
20557@item
20558@value{GDBN} calls the system call
20559
20560@item
20561It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
20562
20563@item
20564If pointer parameters in the request packet point to buffer space in which
20565a system call is expected to copy data to, the data is transmitted to the
20566target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
20567by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
20568packet.
20569
20570@end itemize
20571
20572Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
20573necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
20574
20575@itemize @bullet
20576@item
20577Return value.
20578
20579@item
20580@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
20581
20582@item
20583``Ctrl-C'' flag.
20584
20585@end itemize
20586
20587After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
20588the latest continue or step action.
20589
20590@node The `F' request packet
20591@subsection The @code{F} request packet
20592@cindex file-i/o request packet
20593@cindex @code{F} request packet
20594
20595The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
20596
20597@table @samp
20598
20599@smallexample
20600@code{F}@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20601@end smallexample
20602
20603@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
20604This is just the name of the function.
20605
20606@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
20607
20608@end table
20609
20610Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the real values in case
20611of scalar datatypes, as pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
20612datatypes and unspecified memory areas or as pointer/length pairs in case
20613of string parameters. These are appended to the call-id, each separated
20614from its predecessor by a comma. All values are transmitted in ASCII
20615string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
20616
20617@node The `F' reply packet
20618@subsection The @code{F} reply packet
20619@cindex file-i/o reply packet
20620@cindex @code{F} reply packet
20621
20622The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
20623
20624@table @samp
20625
20626@smallexample
20627@code{F}@var{retcode}@code{,}@var{errno}@code{,}@var{Ctrl-C flag}@code{;}@var{call specific attachment}
20628@end smallexample
20629
20630@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
20631
20632@var{errno} is the errno set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
20633This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
20634
20635@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only send if the user requested a break. In this
20636case, @var{errno} must be send as well, even if the call was successful.
20637The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character 'C':
20638
20639@smallexample
20640F0,0,C
20641@end smallexample
20642
20643@noindent
20644or, if the call was interupted before the host call has been performed:
20645
20646@smallexample
20647F-1,4,C
20648@end smallexample
20649
20650@noindent
20651assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
20652
20653@end table
20654
20655@node Memory transfer
20656@subsection Memory transfer
20657@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
20658
20659Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write as e.g.@:
20660a @code{struct stat} is expected to be in a protocol specific format with
20661all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. This should be done by
20662the target before the @code{F} packet is sent resp.@: by @value{GDBN} before
20663it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
20664data should point to the already coerced data at any time.
20665
20666@node The Ctrl-C message
20667@subsection The Ctrl-C message
20668@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
20669
20670A special case is, if the @var{Ctrl-C flag} is set in the @value{GDBN}
20671reply packet. In this case the target should behave, as if it had
20672gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
20673interupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
20674(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
20675packet. In this case, it's important for the target to know, in which
20676state the system call was interrupted. Since this action is by design
20677not an atomic operation, we have to differ between two cases:
20678
20679@itemize @bullet
20680@item
20681The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
20682
20683@item
20684The system call on the host has been finished.
20685
20686@end itemize
20687
20688These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
20689returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
20690call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
20691on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
20692system call has been finished --- successful or not --- and should behave
20693as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
20694
20695@value{GDBN} must behave reliable. If the system call has not been called
20696yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
20697@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
20698before the user requests a break, the full action must be finshed by
20699@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as they fit.
20700The @code{F} packet may only be send when either nothing has happened
20701or the full action has been completed.
20702
20703@node Console I/O
20704@subsection Console I/O
20705@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
20706
20707By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
20708descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
20709on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
20710(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
20711by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
207120 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
20713conditions is met:
20714
20715@itemize @bullet
20716@item
20717The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, the
20718@code{read}
20719system call is treated as finished.
20720
20721@item
20722The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
20723line feed.
20724
20725@item
20726The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
20727character, especially no Ctrl-D is appended to the input.
20728
20729@end itemize
20730
20731If the user has typed more characters as fit in the buffer given to
20732the read call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
20733either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target or debugging
20734is stopped on users request.
20735
20736@node The isatty call
20737@subsection The isatty(3) call
20738@cindex isatty call, file-i/o protocol
20739
20740A special case in this protocol is the library call @code{isatty} which
20741is implemented as it's own call inside of this protocol. It returns
207421 to the target if the file descriptor given as parameter is attached
20743to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
20744would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
20745needed.
20746
20747@node The system call
20748@subsection The system(3) call
20749@cindex system call, file-i/o protocol
20750
20751The other special case in this protocol is the @code{system} call which
20752is implemented as it's own call, too. @value{GDBN} is taking over the full
20753task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the @code{system}
20754call. The return value of @code{system} is simplified before it's returned
20755to the target. Basically, the only signal transmitted back is @code{EINTR}
20756in case the user pressed @kbd{Ctrl-C}. Otherwise the return value consists
20757entirely of the exit status of the called command.
20758
20759Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is refused to be called
20760by @value{GDBN} by default. The user has to allow this call explicitly by
20761entering
20762
20763@table @samp
20764@kindex set remote system-call-allowed 1
20765@item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1}
20766@end table
20767
20768Disabling the @code{system} call is done by
20769
20770@table @samp
20771@kindex set remote system-call-allowed 0
20772@item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 0}
20773@end table
20774
20775The current setting is shown by typing
20776
20777@table @samp
20778@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
20779@item @code{show remote system-call-allowed}
20780@end table
20781
20782@node List of supported calls
20783@subsection List of supported calls
20784@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
20785
20786@menu
20787* open::
20788* close::
20789* read::
20790* write::
20791* lseek::
20792* rename::
20793* unlink::
20794* stat/fstat::
20795* gettimeofday::
20796* isatty::
20797* system::
20798@end menu
20799
20800@node open
20801@unnumberedsubsubsec open
20802@cindex open, file-i/o system call
20803
20804@smallexample
20805@exdent Synopsis:
20806int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
20807int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
20808
20809@exdent Request:
20810Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode
20811@end smallexample
20812
20813@noindent
20814@code{flags} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20815
20816@table @code
20817@item O_CREAT
20818If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
20819rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
20820are concerned.
20821
20822@item O_EXCL
20823When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is
20824an error and open() fails.
20825
20826@item O_TRUNC
20827If the file already exists and the open mode allows
20828writing (O_RDWR or O_WRONLY is given) it will be
20829truncated to length 0.
20830
20831@item O_APPEND
20832The file is opened in append mode.
20833
20834@item O_RDONLY
20835The file is opened for reading only.
20836
20837@item O_WRONLY
20838The file is opened for writing only.
20839
20840@item O_RDWR
20841The file is opened for reading and writing.
20842
20843@noindent
20844Each other bit is silently ignored.
20845
20846@end table
20847
20848@noindent
20849@code{mode} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20850
20851@table @code
20852@item S_IRUSR
20853User has read permission.
20854
20855@item S_IWUSR
20856User has write permission.
20857
20858@item S_IRGRP
20859Group has read permission.
20860
20861@item S_IWGRP
20862Group has write permission.
20863
20864@item S_IROTH
20865Others have read permission.
20866
20867@item S_IWOTH
20868Others have write permission.
20869
20870@noindent
20871Each other bit is silently ignored.
20872
20873@end table
20874
20875@smallexample
20876@exdent Return value:
20877open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
20878occured.
20879
20880@exdent Errors:
20881@end smallexample
20882
20883@table @code
20884@item EEXIST
20885pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
20886
20887@item EISDIR
20888pathname refers to a directory.
20889
20890@item EACCES
20891The requested access is not allowed.
20892
20893@item ENAMETOOLONG
20894pathname was too long.
20895
20896@item ENOENT
20897A directory component in pathname does not exist.
20898
20899@item ENODEV
20900pathname refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
20901
20902@item EROFS
20903pathname refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
20904write access was requested.
20905
20906@item EFAULT
20907pathname is an invalid pointer value.
20908
20909@item ENOSPC
20910No space on device to create the file.
20911
20912@item EMFILE
20913The process already has the maximum number of files open.
20914
20915@item ENFILE
20916The limit on the total number of files open on the system
20917has been reached.
20918
20919@item EINTR
20920The call was interrupted by the user.
20921@end table
20922
20923@node close
20924@unnumberedsubsubsec close
20925@cindex close, file-i/o system call
20926
20927@smallexample
20928@exdent Synopsis:
20929int close(int fd);
20930
20931@exdent Request:
20932Fclose,fd
20933
20934@exdent Return value:
20935close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
20936
20937@exdent Errors:
20938@end smallexample
20939
20940@table @code
20941@item EBADF
20942fd isn't a valid open file descriptor.
20943
20944@item EINTR
20945The call was interrupted by the user.
20946@end table
20947
20948@node read
20949@unnumberedsubsubsec read
20950@cindex read, file-i/o system call
20951
20952@smallexample
20953@exdent Synopsis:
20954int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
20955
20956@exdent Request:
20957Fread,fd,bufptr,count
20958
20959@exdent Return value:
20960On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
20961Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
20962returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
20963
20964@exdent Errors:
20965@end smallexample
20966
20967@table @code
20968@item EBADF
20969fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
20970reading.
20971
20972@item EFAULT
20973buf is an invalid pointer value.
20974
20975@item EINTR
20976The call was interrupted by the user.
20977@end table
20978
20979@node write
20980@unnumberedsubsubsec write
20981@cindex write, file-i/o system call
20982
20983@smallexample
20984@exdent Synopsis:
20985int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
20986
20987@exdent Request:
20988Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count
20989
20990@exdent Return value:
20991On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
20992Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
20993is returned.
20994
20995@exdent Errors:
20996@end smallexample
20997
20998@table @code
20999@item EBADF
21000fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
21001writing.
21002
21003@item EFAULT
21004buf is an invalid pointer value.
21005
21006@item EFBIG
21007An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
21008host specific maximum file size allowed.
21009
21010@item ENOSPC
21011No space on device to write the data.
21012
21013@item EINTR
21014The call was interrupted by the user.
21015@end table
21016
21017@node lseek
21018@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
21019@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
21020
21021@smallexample
21022@exdent Synopsis:
21023long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
21024
21025@exdent Request:
21026Flseek,fd,offset,flag
21027@end smallexample
21028
21029@code{flag} is one of:
21030
21031@table @code
21032@item SEEK_SET
21033The offset is set to offset bytes.
21034
21035@item SEEK_CUR
21036The offset is set to its current location plus offset
21037bytes.
21038
21039@item SEEK_END
21040The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset
21041bytes.
21042@end table
21043
21044@smallexample
21045@exdent Return value:
21046On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
21047the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
21048value of -1 is returned.
21049
21050@exdent Errors:
21051@end smallexample
21052
21053@table @code
21054@item EBADF
21055fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
21056
21057@item ESPIPE
21058fd is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
21059
21060@item EINVAL
21061flag is not a proper value.
21062
21063@item EINTR
21064The call was interrupted by the user.
21065@end table
21066
21067@node rename
21068@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
21069@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
21070
21071@smallexample
21072@exdent Synopsis:
21073int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
21074
21075@exdent Request:
21076Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len
21077
21078@exdent Return value:
21079On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21080
21081@exdent Errors:
21082@end smallexample
21083
21084@table @code
21085@item EISDIR
21086newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a
21087directory.
21088
21089@item EEXIST
21090newpath is a non-empty directory.
21091
21092@item EBUSY
21093oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some
21094process.
21095
21096@item EINVAL
21097An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
21098of itself.
21099
21100@item ENOTDIR
21101A component used as a directory in oldpath or new
21102path is not a directory. Or oldpath is a directory
21103and newpath exists but is not a directory.
21104
21105@item EFAULT
21106oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
21107
21108@item EACCES
21109No access to the file or the path of the file.
21110
21111@item ENAMETOOLONG
21112
21113oldpath or newpath was too long.
21114
21115@item ENOENT
21116A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
21117
21118@item EROFS
21119The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21120
21121@item ENOSPC
21122The device containing the file has no room for the new
21123directory entry.
21124
21125@item EINTR
21126The call was interrupted by the user.
21127@end table
21128
21129@node unlink
21130@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
21131@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
21132
21133@smallexample
21134@exdent Synopsis:
21135int unlink(const char *pathname);
21136
21137@exdent Request:
21138Funlink,pathnameptr/len
21139
21140@exdent Return value:
21141On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21142
21143@exdent Errors:
21144@end smallexample
21145
21146@table @code
21147@item EACCES
21148No access to the file or the path of the file.
21149
21150@item EPERM
21151The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
21152
21153@item EBUSY
21154The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it's
21155being used by another process.
21156
21157@item EFAULT
21158pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21159
21160@item ENAMETOOLONG
21161pathname was too long.
21162
21163@item ENOENT
21164A directory component in pathname does not exist.
21165
21166@item ENOTDIR
21167A component of the path is not a directory.
21168
21169@item EROFS
21170The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21171
21172@item EINTR
21173The call was interrupted by the user.
21174@end table
21175
21176@node stat/fstat
21177@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
21178@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
21179@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
21180
21181@smallexample
21182@exdent Synopsis:
21183int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
21184int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
21185
21186@exdent Request:
21187Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr
21188Ffstat,fd,bufptr
21189
21190@exdent Return value:
21191On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21192
21193@exdent Errors:
21194@end smallexample
21195
21196@table @code
21197@item EBADF
21198fd is not a valid open file.
21199
21200@item ENOENT
21201A directory component in pathname does not exist or the
21202path is an empty string.
21203
21204@item ENOTDIR
21205A component of the path is not a directory.
21206
21207@item EFAULT
21208pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21209
21210@item EACCES
21211No access to the file or the path of the file.
21212
21213@item ENAMETOOLONG
21214pathname was too long.
21215
21216@item EINTR
21217The call was interrupted by the user.
21218@end table
21219
21220@node gettimeofday
21221@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
21222@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
21223
21224@smallexample
21225@exdent Synopsis:
21226int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
21227
21228@exdent Request:
21229Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr
21230
21231@exdent Return value:
21232On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
21233
21234@exdent Errors:
21235@end smallexample
21236
21237@table @code
21238@item EINVAL
21239tz is a non-NULL pointer.
21240
21241@item EFAULT
21242tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
21243@end table
21244
21245@node isatty
21246@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
21247@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
21248
21249@smallexample
21250@exdent Synopsis:
21251int isatty(int fd);
21252
21253@exdent Request:
21254Fisatty,fd
21255
21256@exdent Return value:
21257Returns 1 if fd refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
21258
21259@exdent Errors:
21260@end smallexample
21261
21262@table @code
21263@item EINTR
21264The call was interrupted by the user.
21265@end table
21266
21267@node system
21268@unnumberedsubsubsec system
21269@cindex system, file-i/o system call
21270
21271@smallexample
21272@exdent Synopsis:
21273int system(const char *command);
21274
21275@exdent Request:
21276Fsystem,commandptr/len
21277
21278@exdent Return value:
21279The value returned is -1 on error and the return status
21280of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
21281command is returned, which is extracted from the hosts
21282system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval).
21283In case /bin/sh could not be executed, 127 is returned.
21284
21285@exdent Errors:
21286@end smallexample
21287
21288@table @code
21289@item EINTR
21290The call was interrupted by the user.
21291@end table
21292
21293@node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21294@subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21295@cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21296
21297@menu
21298* Integral datatypes::
21299* Pointer values::
21300* struct stat::
21301* struct timeval::
21302@end menu
21303
21304@node Integral datatypes
21305@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
21306@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21307
21308The integral datatypes used in the system calls are
21309
21310@smallexample
21311int@r{,} unsigned int@r{,} long@r{,} unsigned long@r{,} mode_t @r{and} time_t
21312@end smallexample
21313
21314@code{Int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
21315implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
21316
21317@code{Long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
21318
21319@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
21320in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
21321
21322@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
21323
21324All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
21325structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
21326byte order.
21327
21328@node Pointer values
21329@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
21330@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
21331
21332Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
21333is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
21334transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
21335are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
21336
21337@smallexample
21338@code{1aaf/12}
21339@end smallexample
21340
21341@noindent
21342which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
21343The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
21344the trailing null byte. Example:
21345
21346@smallexample
21347``hello, world'' at address 0x123456
21348@end smallexample
21349
21350@noindent
21351is transmitted as
21352
21353@smallexample
21354@code{123456/d}
21355@end smallexample
21356
21357@node struct stat
21358@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
21359@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
21360
21361The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and @value{GDBN} is defined
21362as follows:
21363
21364@smallexample
21365struct stat @{
21366 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
21367 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
21368 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
21369 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
21370 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
21371 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
21372 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
21373 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
21374 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
21375 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
21376 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
21377 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
21378 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
21379@};
21380@end smallexample
21381
21382The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21383approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21384structure is of size 64 bytes.
21385
21386The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
21387range of values.
21388
21389@smallexample
21390st_dev: 0 file
21391 1 console
21392
21393st_ino: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21394
21395st_mode: Valid mode bits are described in Appendix C. Any other
21396 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
21397
21398st_uid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21399
21400st_gid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21401
21402st_rdev: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21403
21404st_atime, st_mtime, st_ctime:
21405 These values have a host and file system dependent
21406 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts the file systems
21407 don't support exact timing values.
21408@end smallexample
21409
21410The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is
21411responsible to coerce it to the target representation before
21412continuing.
21413
21414Note that due to size differences between the host and target
21415representation of stat members, these members could eventually
21416get truncated on the target.
21417
21418@node struct timeval
21419@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
21420@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
21421
21422The buffer of type struct timeval used by the target and @value{GDBN}
21423is defined as follows:
21424
21425@smallexample
21426struct timeval @{
21427 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
21428 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
21429@};
21430@end smallexample
21431
21432The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21433approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21434structure is of size 8 bytes.
21435
21436@node Constants
21437@subsection Constants
21438@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
21439
21440The following values are used for the constants inside of the
21441protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are resposible to translate these
21442values before and after the call as needed.
21443
21444@menu
21445* Open flags::
21446* mode_t values::
21447* Errno values::
21448* Lseek flags::
21449* Limits::
21450@end menu
21451
21452@node Open flags
21453@unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
21454@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
21455
21456All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
21457
21458@smallexample
21459 O_RDONLY 0x0
21460 O_WRONLY 0x1
21461 O_RDWR 0x2
21462 O_APPEND 0x8
21463 O_CREAT 0x200
21464 O_TRUNC 0x400
21465 O_EXCL 0x800
21466@end smallexample
21467
21468@node mode_t values
21469@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
21470@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
21471
21472All values are given in octal representation.
21473
21474@smallexample
21475 S_IFREG 0100000
21476 S_IFDIR 040000
21477 S_IRUSR 0400
21478 S_IWUSR 0200
21479 S_IXUSR 0100
21480 S_IRGRP 040
21481 S_IWGRP 020
21482 S_IXGRP 010
21483 S_IROTH 04
21484 S_IWOTH 02
21485 S_IXOTH 01
21486@end smallexample
21487
21488@node Errno values
21489@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
21490@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
21491
21492All values are given in decimal representation.
21493
21494@smallexample
21495 EPERM 1
21496 ENOENT 2
21497 EINTR 4
21498 EBADF 9
21499 EACCES 13
21500 EFAULT 14
21501 EBUSY 16
21502 EEXIST 17
21503 ENODEV 19
21504 ENOTDIR 20
21505 EISDIR 21
21506 EINVAL 22
21507 ENFILE 23
21508 EMFILE 24
21509 EFBIG 27
21510 ENOSPC 28
21511 ESPIPE 29
21512 EROFS 30
21513 ENAMETOOLONG 91
21514 EUNKNOWN 9999
21515@end smallexample
21516
21517 EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
21518 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
21519
21520@node Lseek flags
21521@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
21522@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
21523
21524@smallexample
21525 SEEK_SET 0
21526 SEEK_CUR 1
21527 SEEK_END 2
21528@end smallexample
21529
21530@node Limits
21531@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
21532@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
21533
21534All values are given in decimal representation.
21535
21536@smallexample
21537 INT_MIN -2147483648
21538 INT_MAX 2147483647
21539 UINT_MAX 4294967295
21540 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
21541 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
21542 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
21543@end smallexample
21544
21545@node File-I/O Examples
21546@subsection File-I/O Examples
21547@cindex file-i/o examples
21548
21549Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21550address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
21551
21552@smallexample
21553<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
21554@emph{request memory read from target}
21555-> @code{m1234,6}
21556<- XXXXXX
21557@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
21558-> @code{F6}
21559@end smallexample
21560
21561Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21562address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
21563
21564@smallexample
21565<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21566@emph{request memory write to target}
21567-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21568@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
21569-> @code{F6}
21570@end smallexample
21571
21572Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
21573file descriptor (EBADF):
21574
21575@smallexample
21576<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21577-> @code{F-1,9}
21578@end smallexample
21579
21580Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
21581host is called:
21582
21583@smallexample
21584<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21585-> @code{F-1,4,C}
21586<- @code{T02}
21587@end smallexample
21588
21589Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
21590host is called:
21591
21592@smallexample
21593<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21594-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21595<- @code{T02}
21596@end smallexample
21597
aab4e0ec 21598@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 21599
6826cf00
EZ
21600@include fdl.texi
21601
6d2ebf8b 21602@node Index
c906108c
SS
21603@unnumbered Index
21604
21605@printindex cp
21606
21607@tex
21608% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
21609% meantime:
21610\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
21611\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
21612\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
21613\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
21614\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
21615\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
21616\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
21617\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
21618\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
21619\page\colophon
21620% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
21621@end tex
21622
c906108c 21623@bye
This page took 1.859918 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.